1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 14 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 15 #include <linux/list.h> 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/netlink.h> 18 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 19 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 20 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 21 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 22 #include <linux/net.h> 23 #include <net/regulatory.h> 24 25 /** 26 * DOC: Introduction 27 * 28 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 29 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 30 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 31 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 32 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 33 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 34 * 35 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 36 * use restrictions. 37 */ 38 39 40 /** 41 * DOC: Device registration 42 * 43 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 44 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 45 * described below. 46 * 47 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 48 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 49 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 50 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 51 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 52 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 53 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 54 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 55 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 56 * 57 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 58 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 59 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 60 */ 61 62 struct wiphy; 63 64 /* 65 * wireless hardware capability structures 66 */ 67 68 /** 69 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 70 * 71 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 72 * 73 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 74 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 75 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 78 * is not permitted. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 80 * is not permitted. 81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 83 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 84 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 85 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 86 * restrictions. 87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 88 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 91 * restrictions. 92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 93 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 94 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 95 * on this channel. 96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 97 * on this channel. 98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 102 * on this channel. 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 104 * on this channel. 105 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 106 * on this channel. 107 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 108 * on this channel. 109 * 110 */ 111 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 112 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 113 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 114 /* hole at 1<<2 */ 115 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 116 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 117 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 118 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 119 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 120 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 121 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 131 }; 132 133 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 134 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 135 136 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 137 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 138 139 /** 140 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 141 * 142 * This structure describes a single channel for use 143 * with cfg80211. 144 * 145 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 146 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 147 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 148 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 149 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 150 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 151 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 152 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 153 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 154 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 155 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 156 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 157 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 158 * @orig_mag: internal use 159 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 160 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 161 * on this channel. 162 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 163 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 164 */ 165 struct ieee80211_channel { 166 enum nl80211_band band; 167 u32 center_freq; 168 u16 freq_offset; 169 u16 hw_value; 170 u32 flags; 171 int max_antenna_gain; 172 int max_power; 173 int max_reg_power; 174 bool beacon_found; 175 u32 orig_flags; 176 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 177 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 178 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 179 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 180 }; 181 182 /** 183 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 184 * 185 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 186 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 187 * different bands/PHY modes. 188 * 189 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 190 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 191 * with CCK rates. 192 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 193 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 194 * core code when registering the wiphy. 195 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 196 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 197 * core code when registering the wiphy. 198 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 199 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 200 * core code when registering the wiphy. 201 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 202 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 203 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 204 */ 205 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 206 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 207 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 208 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 209 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 210 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 211 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 212 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 213 }; 214 215 /** 216 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 217 * 218 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 219 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 220 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 221 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 222 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 223 */ 224 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 225 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 226 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 227 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 228 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 229 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 230 }; 231 232 /** 233 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 234 * 235 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 236 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 237 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 238 */ 239 enum ieee80211_privacy { 240 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 241 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 242 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 243 }; 244 245 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 246 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 247 248 /** 249 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 250 * 251 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 252 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 253 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 254 * passed around. 255 * 256 * @flags: rate-specific flags 257 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 258 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 259 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 260 * short preamble is used 261 */ 262 struct ieee80211_rate { 263 u32 flags; 264 u16 bitrate; 265 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 266 }; 267 268 /** 269 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 270 * 271 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 272 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 273 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 274 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 275 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 276 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 277 * members of the SRG 278 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 279 * used by members of the SRG 280 */ 281 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 282 bool enable; 283 u8 sr_ctrl; 284 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 285 u8 min_offset; 286 u8 max_offset; 287 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 288 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 289 }; 290 291 /** 292 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 293 * 294 * @color: the current color. 295 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 296 * @partial: define the AID equation. 297 */ 298 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 299 u8 color; 300 bool enabled; 301 bool partial; 302 }; 303 304 /** 305 * struct ieee80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 306 * 307 * @color: the current color. 308 * @disabled: is the feature disabled. 309 * @partial: define the AID equation. 310 */ 311 struct ieee80211_he_bss_color { 312 u8 color; 313 bool disabled; 314 bool partial; 315 }; 316 317 /** 318 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 319 * 320 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 321 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 322 * 323 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 324 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 325 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 326 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 327 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 328 */ 329 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 330 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 331 bool ht_supported; 332 u8 ampdu_factor; 333 u8 ampdu_density; 334 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 335 }; 336 337 /** 338 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 339 * 340 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 341 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 342 * 343 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 344 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 345 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 346 */ 347 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 348 bool vht_supported; 349 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 350 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 351 }; 352 353 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 354 355 /** 356 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 357 * 358 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 359 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 360 * 361 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 362 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 363 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 364 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 365 */ 366 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 367 bool has_he; 368 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 369 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 370 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 371 }; 372 373 /** 374 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data 375 * 376 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 377 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 378 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 379 * 380 * @types_mask: interface types mask 381 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 382 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 383 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 384 */ 385 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 386 u16 types_mask; 387 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 388 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 389 }; 390 391 /** 392 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 393 * 394 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 395 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 396 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 397 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 398 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 399 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 400 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 401 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 402 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 403 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 404 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 405 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 406 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 407 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 408 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 409 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 410 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 411 */ 412 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 413 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 414 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 415 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 416 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 417 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 418 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 419 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 420 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 421 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 422 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 423 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 424 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 425 }; 426 427 /** 428 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 429 * 430 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 431 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 432 * 433 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 434 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 435 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 436 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 437 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 438 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 439 */ 440 struct ieee80211_edmg { 441 u8 channels; 442 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 443 }; 444 445 /** 446 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 447 * 448 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 449 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 450 * 451 * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA 452 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 453 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 454 */ 455 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 456 bool s1g; 457 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 458 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 459 }; 460 461 /** 462 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 463 * 464 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 465 * is able to operate in. 466 * 467 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 468 * in this band. 469 * @band: the band this structure represents 470 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 471 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 472 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 473 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 474 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 475 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 476 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 477 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 478 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 479 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 480 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 481 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 482 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 483 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 484 * iftype_data). 485 */ 486 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 487 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 488 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 489 enum nl80211_band band; 490 int n_channels; 491 int n_bitrates; 492 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 493 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 494 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 495 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 496 u16 n_iftype_data; 497 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data; 498 }; 499 500 /** 501 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 502 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 503 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 504 * 505 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 506 */ 507 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 508 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 509 u8 iftype) 510 { 511 int i; 512 513 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 514 return NULL; 515 516 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) { 517 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 518 &sband->iftype_data[i]; 519 520 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 521 return data; 522 } 523 524 return NULL; 525 } 526 527 /** 528 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 529 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 530 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 531 * 532 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 533 */ 534 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 535 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 536 u8 iftype) 537 { 538 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 539 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 540 541 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 542 return &data->he_cap; 543 544 return NULL; 545 } 546 547 /** 548 * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA 549 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 550 * 551 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 552 */ 553 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 554 ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband) 555 { 556 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION); 557 } 558 559 /** 560 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 561 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 562 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 563 * 564 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 565 */ 566 static inline __le16 567 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 568 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 569 { 570 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 571 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 572 573 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 574 return 0; 575 576 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 577 } 578 579 /** 580 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 581 * 582 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 583 * 584 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 585 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 586 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 587 * 588 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 589 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 590 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 591 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 592 * without affecting other devices. 593 * 594 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 595 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 596 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 597 */ 598 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 599 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 600 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 601 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 602 { 603 } 604 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 605 606 607 /* 608 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 609 */ 610 611 /** 612 * DOC: Actions and configuration 613 * 614 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 615 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 616 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 617 * operations use are described separately. 618 * 619 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 620 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 621 * 622 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 623 * in a separate chapter. 624 */ 625 626 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 627 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 628 629 /** 630 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 631 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 632 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 633 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 634 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 635 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 636 * determine the address as needed. 637 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 638 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 639 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 640 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 641 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 642 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 643 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 644 */ 645 struct vif_params { 646 u32 flags; 647 int use_4addr; 648 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 649 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 650 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 651 }; 652 653 /** 654 * struct key_params - key information 655 * 656 * Information about a key 657 * 658 * @key: key material 659 * @key_len: length of key material 660 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 661 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 662 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 663 * length given by @seq_len. 664 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 665 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 666 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 667 */ 668 struct key_params { 669 const u8 *key; 670 const u8 *seq; 671 int key_len; 672 int seq_len; 673 u16 vlan_id; 674 u32 cipher; 675 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 676 }; 677 678 /** 679 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 680 * @chan: the (control) channel 681 * @width: channel width 682 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 683 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 684 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 685 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 686 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 687 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 688 * parameters are ignored. 689 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 690 */ 691 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 692 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 693 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 694 u32 center_freq1; 695 u32 center_freq2; 696 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 697 u16 freq1_offset; 698 }; 699 700 /* 701 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 702 */ 703 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 704 struct { 705 u32 legacy; 706 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 707 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 708 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 709 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 710 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 711 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 712 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 713 }; 714 715 716 /** 717 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 718 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 719 * of the peer. 720 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 721 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 722 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 723 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 724 * @retry_long: retry count value 725 * @retry_short: retry count value 726 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 727 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 728 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 729 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 730 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 731 */ 732 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 733 bool config_override; 734 u8 tids; 735 u64 mask; 736 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 737 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 738 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 739 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 740 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 741 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 742 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 743 }; 744 745 /** 746 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 747 * @peer: Station's MAC address 748 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 749 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 750 */ 751 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 752 const u8 *peer; 753 u32 n_tid_conf; 754 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[]; 755 }; 756 757 /** 758 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 759 * @chandef: the channel definition 760 * 761 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 762 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 763 */ 764 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 765 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 766 { 767 switch (chandef->width) { 768 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 769 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 770 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 771 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 772 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 773 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 774 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 775 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 776 default: 777 WARN_ON(1); 778 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 779 } 780 } 781 782 /** 783 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 784 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 785 * @channel: the control channel 786 * @chantype: the channel type 787 * 788 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 789 */ 790 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 791 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 792 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 793 794 /** 795 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 796 * @chandef1: first channel definition 797 * @chandef2: second channel definition 798 * 799 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 800 * identical, %false otherwise. 801 */ 802 static inline bool 803 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 804 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 805 { 806 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 807 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 808 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 809 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 810 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 811 } 812 813 /** 814 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 815 * 816 * @chandef: the channel definition 817 * 818 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 819 */ 820 static inline bool 821 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 822 { 823 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 824 } 825 826 /** 827 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 828 * @chandef1: first channel definition 829 * @chandef2: second channel definition 830 * 831 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 832 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 833 */ 834 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 835 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 836 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 837 838 /** 839 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 840 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 841 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 842 */ 843 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 844 845 /** 846 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 847 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 848 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 849 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 850 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 851 */ 852 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 853 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 854 u32 prohibited_flags); 855 856 /** 857 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 858 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 859 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 860 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 861 * Returns: 862 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 863 */ 864 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 865 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 866 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 867 868 /** 869 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 870 * 871 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 872 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 873 * 874 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 875 * 876 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 877 */ 878 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 879 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 880 { 881 switch (chandef->width) { 882 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 883 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 884 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 885 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 886 default: 887 break; 888 } 889 return 0; 890 } 891 892 /** 893 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 894 * 895 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 896 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 897 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 898 * 899 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 900 * 901 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 902 */ 903 static inline int 904 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 905 { 906 switch (chandef->width) { 907 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 908 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 909 chandef->chan->max_power); 910 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 911 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 912 chandef->chan->max_power); 913 default: 914 break; 915 } 916 return chandef->chan->max_power; 917 } 918 919 /** 920 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 921 * 922 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 923 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 924 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 925 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 926 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 927 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 928 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 929 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 930 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 931 * 932 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 933 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 934 */ 935 enum survey_info_flags { 936 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 937 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 938 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 939 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 940 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 941 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 942 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 943 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 944 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 945 }; 946 947 /** 948 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 949 * 950 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 951 * record to report global statistics 952 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 953 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 954 * optional 955 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 956 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 957 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 958 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 959 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 960 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 961 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 962 * 963 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 964 * 965 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 966 * channel duty cycle etc. 967 */ 968 struct survey_info { 969 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 970 u64 time; 971 u64 time_busy; 972 u64 time_ext_busy; 973 u64 time_rx; 974 u64 time_tx; 975 u64 time_scan; 976 u64 time_bss_rx; 977 u32 filled; 978 s8 noise; 979 }; 980 981 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4 982 983 /** 984 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 985 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 986 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 987 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 988 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 989 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 990 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 991 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 992 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 993 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 994 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 995 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 996 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 997 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 998 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 999 * protocol frames. 1000 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 1001 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 1002 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 1003 * port for mac80211 1004 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 1005 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 1006 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 1007 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 1008 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 1009 * offload) 1010 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1011 */ 1012 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1013 u32 wpa_versions; 1014 u32 cipher_group; 1015 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1016 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1017 int n_akm_suites; 1018 u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES]; 1019 bool control_port; 1020 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1021 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1022 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1023 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1024 struct key_params *wep_keys; 1025 int wep_tx_key; 1026 const u8 *psk; 1027 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1028 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1029 }; 1030 1031 /** 1032 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1033 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1034 * or %NULL if not changed 1035 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1036 * or %NULL if not changed 1037 * @head_len: length of @head 1038 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1039 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1040 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1041 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1042 * frames or %NULL 1043 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1044 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1045 * Response frames or %NULL 1046 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1047 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1048 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1049 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1050 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1051 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1052 * (measurement type 8) 1053 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1054 * Token (measurement type 11) 1055 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1056 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1057 */ 1058 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1059 const u8 *head, *tail; 1060 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1061 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1062 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1063 const u8 *probe_resp; 1064 const u8 *lci; 1065 const u8 *civicloc; 1066 s8 ftm_responder; 1067 1068 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1069 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1070 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1071 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1072 size_t probe_resp_len; 1073 size_t lci_len; 1074 size_t civicloc_len; 1075 }; 1076 1077 struct mac_address { 1078 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1079 }; 1080 1081 /** 1082 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1083 * 1084 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1085 * entry specified by mac_addr 1086 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1087 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1088 */ 1089 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1090 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1091 int n_acl_entries; 1092 1093 /* Keep it last */ 1094 struct mac_address mac_addrs[]; 1095 }; 1096 1097 /** 1098 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1099 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1100 * 1101 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1102 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1103 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1104 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1105 * frame headers. 1106 */ 1107 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1108 u32 min_interval; 1109 u32 max_interval; 1110 size_t tmpl_len; 1111 const u8 *tmpl; 1112 }; 1113 1114 /** 1115 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1116 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1117 * 1118 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1119 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1120 * scanning 1121 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1122 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1123 */ 1124 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1125 u32 interval; 1126 size_t tmpl_len; 1127 const u8 *tmpl; 1128 }; 1129 1130 /** 1131 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 1132 * 1133 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings 1134 * 1135 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication 1136 */ 1137 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags { 1138 AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0), 1139 }; 1140 1141 /** 1142 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1143 * 1144 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1145 * 1146 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1147 * @beacon: beacon data 1148 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1149 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1150 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1151 * user space) 1152 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1153 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1154 * @crypto: crypto settings 1155 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1156 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1157 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1158 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1159 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1160 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1161 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1162 * MAC address based access control 1163 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1164 * networks. 1165 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1166 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1167 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1168 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1169 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1170 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1171 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1172 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1173 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags 1174 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1175 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1176 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1177 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1178 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1179 */ 1180 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1181 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1182 1183 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1184 1185 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1186 const u8 *ssid; 1187 size_t ssid_len; 1188 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1189 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1190 bool privacy; 1191 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1192 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1193 int inactivity_timeout; 1194 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1195 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1196 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1197 bool pbss; 1198 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1199 1200 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1201 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1202 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1203 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1204 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required; 1205 bool twt_responder; 1206 u32 flags; 1207 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1208 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1209 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1210 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1211 }; 1212 1213 /** 1214 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1215 * 1216 * Used for channel switch 1217 * 1218 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1219 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1220 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1221 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1222 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1223 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1224 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1225 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1226 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1227 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1228 */ 1229 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1230 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1231 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1232 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1233 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1234 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1235 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1236 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1237 bool radar_required; 1238 bool block_tx; 1239 u8 count; 1240 }; 1241 1242 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10 1243 1244 /** 1245 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1246 * 1247 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1248 * 1249 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1250 * to use for verification 1251 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1252 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1253 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1254 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1255 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1256 * nl80211_iftype. 1257 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1258 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1259 * the verification 1260 */ 1261 struct iface_combination_params { 1262 int num_different_channels; 1263 u8 radar_detect; 1264 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1265 u32 new_beacon_int; 1266 }; 1267 1268 /** 1269 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1270 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1271 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1272 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1273 * 1274 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1275 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1276 */ 1277 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1278 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1279 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1280 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1281 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3), 1282 }; 1283 1284 /** 1285 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1286 * 1287 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1288 * 1289 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1290 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1291 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1292 * power per-interface or per-station. 1293 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1294 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1295 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1296 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1297 * per peer TPC. 1298 */ 1299 struct sta_txpwr { 1300 s16 power; 1301 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1302 }; 1303 1304 /** 1305 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1306 * 1307 * Used to change and create a new station. 1308 * 1309 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1310 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1311 * (or NULL for no change) 1312 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1313 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1314 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1315 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1316 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1317 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1318 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1319 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1320 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1321 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1322 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1323 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1324 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1325 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1326 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1327 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1328 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1329 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1330 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1331 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1332 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1333 * to unknown) 1334 * @capability: station capability 1335 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1336 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1337 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1338 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1339 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1340 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1341 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1342 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1343 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1344 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1345 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1346 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1347 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1348 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1349 */ 1350 struct station_parameters { 1351 const u8 *supported_rates; 1352 struct net_device *vlan; 1353 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1354 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1355 int listen_interval; 1356 u16 aid; 1357 u16 vlan_id; 1358 u16 peer_aid; 1359 u8 supported_rates_len; 1360 u8 plink_action; 1361 u8 plink_state; 1362 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1363 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1364 u8 uapsd_queues; 1365 u8 max_sp; 1366 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1367 u16 capability; 1368 const u8 *ext_capab; 1369 u8 ext_capab_len; 1370 const u8 *supported_channels; 1371 u8 supported_channels_len; 1372 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1373 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1374 u8 opmode_notif; 1375 bool opmode_notif_used; 1376 int support_p2p_ps; 1377 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1378 u8 he_capa_len; 1379 u16 airtime_weight; 1380 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1381 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1382 }; 1383 1384 /** 1385 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1386 * 1387 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1388 * 1389 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1390 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1391 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1392 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1393 */ 1394 struct station_del_parameters { 1395 const u8 *mac; 1396 u8 subtype; 1397 u16 reason_code; 1398 }; 1399 1400 /** 1401 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1402 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1403 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1404 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1405 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1406 * the AP MLME in the device 1407 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1408 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1409 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1410 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1411 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1412 * supported/used) 1413 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1414 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1415 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1416 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1417 */ 1418 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1419 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1420 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1421 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1422 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1423 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1424 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1425 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1426 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1427 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1428 }; 1429 1430 /** 1431 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1432 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1433 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1434 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1435 * 1436 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1437 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1438 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1439 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1440 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1441 */ 1442 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1443 struct station_parameters *params, 1444 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1445 1446 /** 1447 * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags 1448 * 1449 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1450 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1451 * 1452 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1453 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1454 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1455 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1456 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1457 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1458 */ 1459 enum rate_info_flags { 1460 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1461 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1462 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1463 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1464 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1465 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1466 }; 1467 1468 /** 1469 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1470 * 1471 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1472 * 1473 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1474 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1475 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1476 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1477 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1478 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1479 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1480 */ 1481 enum rate_info_bw { 1482 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1483 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1484 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1485 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1486 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1487 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1488 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1489 }; 1490 1491 /** 1492 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1493 * 1494 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1495 * 1496 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1497 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate 1498 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1499 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1500 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1501 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1502 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1503 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1504 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1505 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1506 */ 1507 struct rate_info { 1508 u8 flags; 1509 u8 mcs; 1510 u16 legacy; 1511 u8 nss; 1512 u8 bw; 1513 u8 he_gi; 1514 u8 he_dcm; 1515 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1516 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1517 }; 1518 1519 /** 1520 * enum station_info_rate_flags - bitrate info flags 1521 * 1522 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1523 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1524 * 1525 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1526 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1527 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1528 */ 1529 enum bss_param_flags { 1530 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1531 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1532 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1533 }; 1534 1535 /** 1536 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1537 * 1538 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1539 * 1540 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1541 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1542 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1543 */ 1544 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1545 u8 flags; 1546 u8 dtim_period; 1547 u16 beacon_interval; 1548 }; 1549 1550 /** 1551 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1552 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1553 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1554 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1555 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1556 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1557 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1558 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1559 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1560 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1561 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1562 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1563 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1564 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1565 */ 1566 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1567 u32 filled; 1568 u32 backlog_bytes; 1569 u32 backlog_packets; 1570 u32 flows; 1571 u32 drops; 1572 u32 ecn_marks; 1573 u32 overlimit; 1574 u32 overmemory; 1575 u32 collisions; 1576 u32 tx_bytes; 1577 u32 tx_packets; 1578 u32 max_flows; 1579 }; 1580 1581 /** 1582 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1583 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1584 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1585 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1586 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1587 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1588 * transmitted MSDUs 1589 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1590 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1591 */ 1592 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1593 u32 filled; 1594 u64 rx_msdu; 1595 u64 tx_msdu; 1596 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1597 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1598 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1599 }; 1600 1601 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1602 1603 /** 1604 * struct station_info - station information 1605 * 1606 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1607 * 1608 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1609 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1610 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1611 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1612 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1613 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1614 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1615 * @llid: mesh local link id 1616 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1617 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1618 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1619 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1620 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1621 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1622 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1623 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1624 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1625 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1626 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1627 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1628 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1629 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1630 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 1631 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 1632 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 1633 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1634 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 1635 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1636 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1637 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 1638 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 1639 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 1640 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 1641 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 1642 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 1643 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 1644 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 1645 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 1646 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 1647 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 1648 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 1649 * towards this station. 1650 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 1651 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 1652 * from this peer 1653 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 1654 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 1655 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 1656 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 1657 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 1658 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 1659 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 1660 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 1661 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 1662 * been sent. 1663 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 1664 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 1665 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 1666 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 1667 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 1668 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 1669 */ 1670 struct station_info { 1671 u64 filled; 1672 u32 connected_time; 1673 u32 inactive_time; 1674 u64 assoc_at; 1675 u64 rx_bytes; 1676 u64 tx_bytes; 1677 u16 llid; 1678 u16 plid; 1679 u8 plink_state; 1680 s8 signal; 1681 s8 signal_avg; 1682 1683 u8 chains; 1684 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1685 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1686 1687 struct rate_info txrate; 1688 struct rate_info rxrate; 1689 u32 rx_packets; 1690 u32 tx_packets; 1691 u32 tx_retries; 1692 u32 tx_failed; 1693 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 1694 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 1695 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 1696 1697 int generation; 1698 1699 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 1700 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 1701 1702 u32 beacon_loss_count; 1703 s64 t_offset; 1704 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1705 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 1706 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 1707 1708 u32 expected_throughput; 1709 1710 u64 tx_duration; 1711 u64 rx_duration; 1712 u64 rx_beacon; 1713 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 1714 u8 connected_to_gate; 1715 1716 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 1717 s8 ack_signal; 1718 s8 avg_ack_signal; 1719 1720 u16 airtime_weight; 1721 1722 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 1723 u32 fcs_err_count; 1724 1725 u32 airtime_link_metric; 1726 1727 u8 connected_to_as; 1728 }; 1729 1730 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 1731 /** 1732 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 1733 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 1734 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 1735 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 1736 * 1737 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 1738 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 1739 * considered undefined. 1740 */ 1741 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 1742 struct station_info *sinfo); 1743 #else 1744 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 1745 const u8 *mac_addr, 1746 struct station_info *sinfo) 1747 { 1748 return -ENOENT; 1749 } 1750 #endif 1751 1752 /** 1753 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 1754 * 1755 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 1756 * according to the nl80211 flags. 1757 * 1758 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 1759 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 1760 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 1761 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 1762 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 1763 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 1764 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 1765 */ 1766 enum monitor_flags { 1767 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 1768 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 1769 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 1770 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 1771 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 1772 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 1773 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 1774 }; 1775 1776 /** 1777 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 1778 * 1779 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 1780 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 1781 * 1782 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 1783 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 1784 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 1785 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 1786 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 1787 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 1788 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 1789 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 1790 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 1791 */ 1792 enum mpath_info_flags { 1793 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 1794 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 1795 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 1796 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 1797 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 1798 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 1799 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 1800 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 1801 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 1802 }; 1803 1804 /** 1805 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 1806 * 1807 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 1808 * 1809 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 1810 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 1811 * @sn: target sequence number 1812 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 1813 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 1814 * @flags: mesh path flags 1815 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 1816 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 1817 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1818 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 1819 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1820 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1821 * @hop_count: hops to destination 1822 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 1823 */ 1824 struct mpath_info { 1825 u32 filled; 1826 u32 frame_qlen; 1827 u32 sn; 1828 u32 metric; 1829 u32 exptime; 1830 u32 discovery_timeout; 1831 u8 discovery_retries; 1832 u8 flags; 1833 u8 hop_count; 1834 u32 path_change_count; 1835 1836 int generation; 1837 }; 1838 1839 /** 1840 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 1841 * 1842 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 1843 * 1844 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 1845 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1846 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 1847 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1848 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 1849 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1850 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1851 * (or NULL for no change) 1852 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 1853 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 1854 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1855 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 1856 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 1857 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 1858 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 1859 */ 1860 struct bss_parameters { 1861 int use_cts_prot; 1862 int use_short_preamble; 1863 int use_short_slot_time; 1864 const u8 *basic_rates; 1865 u8 basic_rates_len; 1866 int ap_isolate; 1867 int ht_opmode; 1868 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 1869 }; 1870 1871 /** 1872 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 1873 * 1874 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 1875 * 1876 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 1877 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 1878 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 1879 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 1880 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 1881 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 1882 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 1883 * mesh interface 1884 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 1885 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 1886 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 1887 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 1888 * elements 1889 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 1890 * detect compatible mesh peers 1891 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 1892 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 1893 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 1894 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 1895 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 1896 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 1897 * a path discovery in milliseconds 1898 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1899 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 1900 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 1901 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1902 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 1903 * element 1904 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1905 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 1906 * element 1907 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 1908 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 1909 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 1910 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 1911 * announcements are transmitted 1912 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 1913 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 1914 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 1915 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 1916 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 1917 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 1918 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 1919 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 1920 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 1921 * station to establish a peer link 1922 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 1923 * 1924 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1925 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 1926 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 1927 * 1928 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 1929 * PREQs are transmitted. 1930 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 1931 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 1932 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 1933 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 1934 * setting for new peer links. 1935 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 1936 * after transmitting its beacon. 1937 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 1938 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 1939 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 1940 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 1941 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 1942 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 1943 * in the mesh path table 1944 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 1945 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 1946 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 1947 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 1948 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 1949 */ 1950 struct mesh_config { 1951 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 1952 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 1953 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 1954 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 1955 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 1956 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 1957 u8 element_ttl; 1958 bool auto_open_plinks; 1959 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 1960 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 1961 u32 path_refresh_time; 1962 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 1963 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 1964 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 1965 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 1966 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 1967 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 1968 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 1969 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 1970 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 1971 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 1972 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 1973 s32 rssi_threshold; 1974 u16 ht_opmode; 1975 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 1976 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 1977 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 1978 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 1979 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 1980 u32 plink_timeout; 1981 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 1982 }; 1983 1984 /** 1985 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 1986 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1987 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 1988 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 1989 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 1990 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 1991 * @path_metric: which metric to use 1992 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 1993 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 1994 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 1995 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 1996 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 1997 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 1998 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 1999 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2000 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2001 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2002 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2003 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2004 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2005 * to operate on DFS channels. 2006 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2007 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2008 * 2009 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2010 */ 2011 struct mesh_setup { 2012 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2013 const u8 *mesh_id; 2014 u8 mesh_id_len; 2015 u8 sync_method; 2016 u8 path_sel_proto; 2017 u8 path_metric; 2018 u8 auth_id; 2019 const u8 *ie; 2020 u8 ie_len; 2021 bool is_authenticated; 2022 bool is_secure; 2023 bool user_mpm; 2024 u8 dtim_period; 2025 u16 beacon_interval; 2026 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2027 u32 basic_rates; 2028 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2029 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2030 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2031 }; 2032 2033 /** 2034 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2035 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2036 * 2037 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2038 */ 2039 struct ocb_setup { 2040 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2041 }; 2042 2043 /** 2044 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2045 * @ac: AC identifier 2046 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2047 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2048 * 1..32767] 2049 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2050 * 1..32767] 2051 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2052 */ 2053 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2054 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2055 u16 txop; 2056 u16 cwmin; 2057 u16 cwmax; 2058 u8 aifs; 2059 }; 2060 2061 /** 2062 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2063 * 2064 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2065 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2066 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2067 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2068 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2069 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2070 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2071 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2072 * in the wiphy structure. 2073 * 2074 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2075 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2076 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2077 * 2078 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2079 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2080 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2081 * to userspace. 2082 */ 2083 2084 /** 2085 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2086 * @ssid: the SSID 2087 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2088 */ 2089 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2090 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2091 u8 ssid_len; 2092 }; 2093 2094 /** 2095 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2096 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2097 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2098 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2099 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2100 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2101 * userspace will be notified of that 2102 */ 2103 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2104 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2105 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2106 bool aborted; 2107 }; 2108 2109 /** 2110 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2111 * 2112 * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for 2113 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2114 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2115 * which the above info relvant to 2116 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2117 * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used 2118 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2119 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2120 */ 2121 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2122 u32 short_ssid; 2123 u32 channel_idx; 2124 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2125 bool unsolicited_probe; 2126 bool short_ssid_valid; 2127 bool psc_no_listen; 2128 }; 2129 2130 /** 2131 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2132 * 2133 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2134 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2135 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2136 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2137 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2138 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2139 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2140 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2141 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2142 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2143 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2144 * %duration field. 2145 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2146 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2147 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2148 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2149 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2150 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2151 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2152 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2153 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2154 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2155 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2156 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2157 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2158 * true if this is the second scan request 2159 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2160 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2161 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2162 */ 2163 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2164 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2165 int n_ssids; 2166 u32 n_channels; 2167 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2168 const u8 *ie; 2169 size_t ie_len; 2170 u16 duration; 2171 bool duration_mandatory; 2172 u32 flags; 2173 2174 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2175 2176 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2177 2178 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2179 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2180 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2181 2182 /* internal */ 2183 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2184 unsigned long scan_start; 2185 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2186 bool notified; 2187 bool no_cck; 2188 bool scan_6ghz; 2189 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2190 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2191 2192 /* keep last */ 2193 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2194 }; 2195 2196 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2197 { 2198 int i; 2199 2200 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2201 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2202 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2203 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2204 } 2205 } 2206 2207 /** 2208 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2209 * 2210 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2211 * or no match (RSSI only) 2212 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2213 * or no match (RSSI only) 2214 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2215 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2216 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support 2217 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2218 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2219 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2220 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2221 * corresponding matchset. 2222 */ 2223 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2224 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2225 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2226 s32 rssi_thold; 2227 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2228 }; 2229 2230 /** 2231 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2232 * 2233 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2234 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2235 * infinite loop. 2236 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2237 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2238 */ 2239 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2240 u32 interval; 2241 u32 iterations; 2242 }; 2243 2244 /** 2245 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2246 * 2247 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2248 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2249 */ 2250 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2251 enum nl80211_band band; 2252 s8 delta; 2253 }; 2254 2255 /** 2256 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2257 * 2258 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2259 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2260 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2261 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2262 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2263 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2264 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2265 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2266 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2267 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2268 * (others are filtered out). 2269 * If ommited, all results are passed. 2270 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2271 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2272 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2273 * @dev: the interface 2274 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2275 * @channels: channels to scan 2276 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2277 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2278 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2279 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2280 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2281 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2282 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2283 * index must be executed first. 2284 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2285 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2286 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2287 * owned by a particular socket) 2288 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2289 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2290 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2291 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2292 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2293 * supported. 2294 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2295 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2296 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2297 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2298 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2299 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2300 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2301 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2302 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2303 * comparisions. 2304 */ 2305 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2306 u64 reqid; 2307 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2308 int n_ssids; 2309 u32 n_channels; 2310 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2311 const u8 *ie; 2312 size_t ie_len; 2313 u32 flags; 2314 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2315 int n_match_sets; 2316 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2317 u32 delay; 2318 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2319 int n_scan_plans; 2320 2321 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2322 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2323 2324 bool relative_rssi_set; 2325 s8 relative_rssi; 2326 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2327 2328 /* internal */ 2329 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2330 struct net_device *dev; 2331 unsigned long scan_start; 2332 bool report_results; 2333 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2334 u32 owner_nlportid; 2335 bool nl_owner_dead; 2336 struct list_head list; 2337 2338 /* keep last */ 2339 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2340 }; 2341 2342 /** 2343 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2344 * 2345 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2346 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2347 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2348 */ 2349 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2350 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2351 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2352 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2353 }; 2354 2355 /** 2356 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2357 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2358 * @scan_width: scan width that was used 2359 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2360 * signal type 2361 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2362 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2363 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2364 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2365 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2366 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2367 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2368 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2369 * by %parent_bssid. 2370 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2371 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2372 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2373 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2374 */ 2375 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2376 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2377 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2378 s32 signal; 2379 u64 boottime_ns; 2380 u64 parent_tsf; 2381 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2382 u8 chains; 2383 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2384 }; 2385 2386 /** 2387 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2388 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2389 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2390 * @len: length of the IEs 2391 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2392 * @data: IE data 2393 */ 2394 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2395 u64 tsf; 2396 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2397 int len; 2398 bool from_beacon; 2399 u8 data[]; 2400 }; 2401 2402 /** 2403 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2404 * 2405 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2406 * for use in scan results and similar. 2407 * 2408 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2409 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 2410 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2411 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2412 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2413 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2414 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2415 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2416 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2417 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2418 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2419 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2420 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2421 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2422 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2423 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2424 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2425 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2426 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2427 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2428 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2429 * (multi-BSSID support) 2430 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2431 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2432 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2433 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2434 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2435 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2436 */ 2437 struct cfg80211_bss { 2438 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2439 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2440 2441 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2442 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2443 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2444 2445 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2446 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2447 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2448 2449 s32 signal; 2450 2451 u16 beacon_interval; 2452 u16 capability; 2453 2454 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2455 u8 chains; 2456 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2457 2458 u8 bssid_index; 2459 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2460 2461 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2462 }; 2463 2464 /** 2465 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2466 * @bss: the bss to search 2467 * @id: the element ID 2468 * 2469 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2470 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2471 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2472 */ 2473 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2474 2475 /** 2476 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2477 * @bss: the bss to search 2478 * @id: the element ID 2479 * 2480 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2481 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2482 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2483 */ 2484 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2485 { 2486 return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2487 } 2488 2489 2490 /** 2491 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2492 * 2493 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2494 * authentication. 2495 * 2496 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2497 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2498 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2499 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2500 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2501 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2502 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2503 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2504 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2505 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2506 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2507 * transaction sequence number field. 2508 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2509 */ 2510 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2511 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2512 const u8 *ie; 2513 size_t ie_len; 2514 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2515 const u8 *key; 2516 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2517 const u8 *auth_data; 2518 size_t auth_data_len; 2519 }; 2520 2521 /** 2522 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2523 * 2524 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 2525 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 2526 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 2527 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 2528 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 2529 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 2530 * request (connect callback). 2531 */ 2532 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 2533 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 2534 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 2535 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 2536 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 2537 }; 2538 2539 /** 2540 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 2541 * 2542 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2543 * (re)association. 2544 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 2545 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 2546 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 2547 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 2548 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 2549 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2550 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 2551 * @crypto: crypto settings 2552 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2553 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2554 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2555 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2556 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2557 * frame. 2558 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2559 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2560 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2561 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2562 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 2563 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 2564 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 2565 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 2566 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 2567 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 2568 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 2569 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2570 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 2571 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 2572 */ 2573 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 2574 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2575 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 2576 size_t ie_len; 2577 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2578 bool use_mfp; 2579 u32 flags; 2580 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2581 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2582 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 2583 const u8 *fils_kek; 2584 size_t fils_kek_len; 2585 const u8 *fils_nonces; 2586 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 2587 }; 2588 2589 /** 2590 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 2591 * 2592 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2593 * deauthentication. 2594 * 2595 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from 2596 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 2597 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2598 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 2599 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 2600 * do not set a deauth frame 2601 */ 2602 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 2603 const u8 *bssid; 2604 const u8 *ie; 2605 size_t ie_len; 2606 u16 reason_code; 2607 bool local_state_change; 2608 }; 2609 2610 /** 2611 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 2612 * 2613 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2614 * disassociation. 2615 * 2616 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from 2617 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 2618 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2619 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 2620 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 2621 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 2622 */ 2623 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 2624 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2625 const u8 *ie; 2626 size_t ie_len; 2627 u16 reason_code; 2628 bool local_state_change; 2629 }; 2630 2631 /** 2632 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 2633 * 2634 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 2635 * method. 2636 * 2637 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 2638 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 2639 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 2640 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 2641 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 2642 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 2643 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 2644 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 2645 * @ie_len: length of that 2646 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2647 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 2648 * after joining 2649 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 2650 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 2651 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 2652 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 2653 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2654 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2655 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2656 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2657 * to operate on DFS channels. 2658 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 2659 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 2660 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2661 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2662 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2663 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 2664 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 2665 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 2666 */ 2667 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 2668 const u8 *ssid; 2669 const u8 *bssid; 2670 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2671 const u8 *ie; 2672 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 2673 u16 beacon_interval; 2674 u32 basic_rates; 2675 bool channel_fixed; 2676 bool privacy; 2677 bool control_port; 2678 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2679 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2680 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2681 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2682 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2683 struct key_params *wep_keys; 2684 int wep_tx_key; 2685 }; 2686 2687 /** 2688 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 2689 * 2690 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 2691 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 2692 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 2693 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 2694 */ 2695 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 2696 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 2697 union { 2698 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 2699 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 2700 } param; 2701 }; 2702 2703 /** 2704 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 2705 * 2706 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2707 * authentication and association. 2708 * 2709 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 2710 * on scan results) 2711 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 2712 * %NULL if not specified 2713 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 2714 * results) 2715 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 2716 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 2717 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 2718 * to use. 2719 * @ssid: SSID 2720 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 2721 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2722 * @ie: IEs for association request 2723 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 2724 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 2725 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 2726 * @crypto: crypto settings 2727 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2728 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2729 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2730 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2731 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 2732 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 2733 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2734 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2735 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2736 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 2737 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 2738 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 2739 * networks. 2740 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 2741 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2742 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2743 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2744 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2745 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2746 * frame. 2747 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 2748 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 2749 * data IE. 2750 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 2751 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 2752 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 2753 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2754 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 2755 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 2756 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2757 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 2758 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 2759 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 2760 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 2761 * offload of 4-way handshake. 2762 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 2763 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 2764 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 2765 */ 2766 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 2767 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2768 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 2769 const u8 *bssid; 2770 const u8 *bssid_hint; 2771 const u8 *ssid; 2772 size_t ssid_len; 2773 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2774 const u8 *ie; 2775 size_t ie_len; 2776 bool privacy; 2777 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 2778 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2779 const u8 *key; 2780 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2781 u32 flags; 2782 int bg_scan_period; 2783 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2784 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2785 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 2786 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 2787 bool pbss; 2788 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 2789 const u8 *prev_bssid; 2790 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 2791 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 2792 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 2793 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 2794 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 2795 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 2796 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 2797 bool want_1x; 2798 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 2799 }; 2800 2801 /** 2802 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 2803 * 2804 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 2805 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 2806 * 2807 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 2808 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 2809 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 2810 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 2811 */ 2812 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 2813 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 2814 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 2815 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 2816 }; 2817 2818 /** 2819 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 2820 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 2821 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 2822 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 2823 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 2824 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 2825 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 2826 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 2827 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 2828 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 2829 */ 2830 enum wiphy_params_flags { 2831 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 2832 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 2833 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 2834 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 2835 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 2836 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 2837 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 2838 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 2839 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 2840 }; 2841 2842 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 2843 2844 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 2845 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 2846 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 2847 2848 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 2849 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 2850 2851 /** 2852 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 2853 * 2854 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 2855 * caching. 2856 * 2857 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 2858 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 2859 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 2860 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 2861 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 2862 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 2863 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 2864 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 2865 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 2866 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 2867 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 2868 * %NULL). 2869 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 2870 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 2871 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 2872 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 2873 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 2874 * used for it expires. 2875 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 2876 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 2877 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 2878 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 2879 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 2880 */ 2881 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 2882 const u8 *bssid; 2883 const u8 *pmkid; 2884 const u8 *pmk; 2885 size_t pmk_len; 2886 const u8 *ssid; 2887 size_t ssid_len; 2888 const u8 *cache_id; 2889 u32 pmk_lifetime; 2890 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 2891 }; 2892 2893 /** 2894 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 2895 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 2896 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 2897 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 2898 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 2899 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 2900 * 2901 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 2902 * memory, free @mask only! 2903 */ 2904 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 2905 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 2906 int pattern_len; 2907 int pkt_offset; 2908 }; 2909 2910 /** 2911 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 2912 * 2913 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 2914 * @src: source IP address 2915 * @dst: destination IP address 2916 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 2917 * @src_port: source port 2918 * @dst_port: destination port 2919 * @payload_len: data payload length 2920 * @payload: data payload buffer 2921 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 2922 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 2923 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 2924 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 2925 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 2926 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 2927 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 2928 */ 2929 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 2930 struct socket *sock; 2931 __be32 src, dst; 2932 u16 src_port, dst_port; 2933 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 2934 int payload_len; 2935 const u8 *payload; 2936 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 2937 u32 data_interval; 2938 u32 wake_len; 2939 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 2940 u32 tokens_size; 2941 /* must be last, variable member */ 2942 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 2943 }; 2944 2945 /** 2946 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 2947 * 2948 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 2949 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 2950 * operating as normal during suspend 2951 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 2952 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 2953 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 2954 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 2955 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 2956 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 2957 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 2958 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 2959 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 2960 * NULL if not configured. 2961 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 2962 */ 2963 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 2964 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 2965 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 2966 rfkill_release; 2967 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 2968 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 2969 int n_patterns; 2970 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 2971 }; 2972 2973 /** 2974 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 2975 * 2976 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 2977 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 2978 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 2979 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 2980 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 2981 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 2982 */ 2983 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 2984 int delay; 2985 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 2986 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 2987 int n_patterns; 2988 }; 2989 2990 /** 2991 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 2992 * 2993 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 2994 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 2995 * @n_rules: number of rules 2996 */ 2997 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 2998 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 2999 int n_rules; 3000 }; 3001 3002 /** 3003 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3004 * 3005 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3006 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3007 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3008 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3009 * occurred (in MHz) 3010 */ 3011 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3012 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3013 int n_channels; 3014 u32 channels[]; 3015 }; 3016 3017 /** 3018 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3019 * 3020 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3021 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3022 * match information. 3023 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3024 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3025 */ 3026 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3027 int n_matches; 3028 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3029 }; 3030 3031 /** 3032 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3033 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3034 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3035 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3036 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3037 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3038 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3039 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3040 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3041 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3042 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3043 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3044 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3045 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3046 * it is. 3047 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3048 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3049 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3050 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3051 */ 3052 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3053 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3054 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3055 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3056 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3057 s32 pattern_idx; 3058 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3059 const void *packet; 3060 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3061 }; 3062 3063 /** 3064 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3065 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3066 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3067 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3068 * @kek_len: length of kek 3069 * @kck_len length of kck 3070 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3071 */ 3072 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3073 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3074 u32 akm; 3075 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3076 }; 3077 3078 /** 3079 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3080 * 3081 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3082 * 3083 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3084 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3085 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3086 */ 3087 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3088 u16 md; 3089 const u8 *ie; 3090 size_t ie_len; 3091 }; 3092 3093 /** 3094 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3095 * 3096 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3097 * 3098 * @chan: channel to use 3099 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required 3100 * @wait: duration for ROC 3101 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3102 * @len: buffer length 3103 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3104 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3105 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3106 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3107 */ 3108 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3109 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3110 bool offchan; 3111 unsigned int wait; 3112 const u8 *buf; 3113 size_t len; 3114 bool no_cck; 3115 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3116 int n_csa_offsets; 3117 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3118 }; 3119 3120 /** 3121 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3122 * 3123 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3124 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3125 */ 3126 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3127 u8 dscp; 3128 u8 up; 3129 }; 3130 3131 /** 3132 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3133 * 3134 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3135 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3136 */ 3137 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3138 u8 low; 3139 u8 high; 3140 }; 3141 3142 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3143 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3144 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3145 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3146 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3147 3148 /** 3149 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3150 * 3151 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3152 * 3153 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3154 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3155 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3156 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3157 */ 3158 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3159 u8 num_des; 3160 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3161 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3162 }; 3163 3164 /** 3165 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3166 * 3167 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3168 * 3169 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3170 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3171 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3172 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3173 */ 3174 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3175 u8 master_pref; 3176 u8 bands; 3177 }; 3178 3179 /** 3180 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3181 * configuration 3182 * 3183 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3184 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3185 */ 3186 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3187 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3188 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3189 }; 3190 3191 /** 3192 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3193 * 3194 * @filter: the content of the filter 3195 * @len: the length of the filter 3196 */ 3197 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3198 const u8 *filter; 3199 u8 len; 3200 }; 3201 3202 /** 3203 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3204 * 3205 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3206 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3207 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3208 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3209 * implementation specific. 3210 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3211 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3212 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3213 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up 3214 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3215 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3216 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3217 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3218 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3219 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3220 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3221 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3222 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3223 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3224 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3225 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3226 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3227 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3228 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3229 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3230 */ 3231 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3232 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3233 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3234 u8 publish_type; 3235 bool close_range; 3236 bool publish_bcast; 3237 bool subscribe_active; 3238 u8 followup_id; 3239 u8 followup_reqid; 3240 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3241 u32 ttl; 3242 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3243 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3244 bool srf_include; 3245 const u8 *srf_bf; 3246 u8 srf_bf_len; 3247 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3248 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3249 int srf_num_macs; 3250 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3251 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3252 u8 num_tx_filters; 3253 u8 num_rx_filters; 3254 u8 instance_id; 3255 u64 cookie; 3256 }; 3257 3258 /** 3259 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3260 * 3261 * @aa: authenticator address 3262 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3263 * @pmk: the PMK material 3264 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3265 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3266 * holds PMK-R0. 3267 */ 3268 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3269 const u8 *aa; 3270 u8 pmk_len; 3271 const u8 *pmk; 3272 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3273 }; 3274 3275 /** 3276 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3277 * 3278 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3279 * 3280 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3281 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3282 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3283 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3284 * authentication response command interface. 3285 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3286 * authentication response command interface. 3287 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3288 * authentication request event interface. 3289 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3290 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3291 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3292 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3293 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3294 */ 3295 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3296 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3297 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3298 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3299 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3300 u16 status; 3301 const u8 *pmkid; 3302 }; 3303 3304 /** 3305 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3306 * 3307 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3308 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3309 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3310 * answered 3311 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3312 * successfully answered 3313 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3314 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3315 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3316 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3317 * of how much time the responder was busy 3318 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3319 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3320 * the responder 3321 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3322 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3323 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3324 */ 3325 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3326 u32 filled; 3327 u32 success_num; 3328 u32 partial_num; 3329 u32 failed_num; 3330 u32 asap_num; 3331 u32 non_asap_num; 3332 u64 total_duration_ms; 3333 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3334 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3335 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3336 }; 3337 3338 /** 3339 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3340 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3341 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3342 * reason than just "failure" 3343 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3344 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3345 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3346 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3347 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3348 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3349 * by the responder 3350 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3351 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3352 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3353 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3354 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3355 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3356 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3357 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3358 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3359 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3360 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3361 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3362 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3363 * the square root of the variance) 3364 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3365 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3366 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3367 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3368 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3369 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3370 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3371 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3372 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3373 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3374 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3375 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3376 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3377 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3378 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3379 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3380 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3381 */ 3382 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3383 const u8 *lci; 3384 const u8 *civicloc; 3385 unsigned int lci_len; 3386 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3387 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3388 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3389 s16 burst_index; 3390 u8 busy_retry_time; 3391 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3392 u8 burst_duration; 3393 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3394 s32 rssi_avg; 3395 s32 rssi_spread; 3396 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3397 s64 rtt_avg; 3398 s64 rtt_variance; 3399 s64 rtt_spread; 3400 s64 dist_avg; 3401 s64 dist_variance; 3402 s64 dist_spread; 3403 3404 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3405 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3406 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3407 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3408 tx_rate_valid:1, 3409 rx_rate_valid:1, 3410 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3411 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3412 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3413 dist_avg_valid:1, 3414 dist_variance_valid:1, 3415 dist_spread_valid:1; 3416 }; 3417 3418 /** 3419 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3420 * @addr: address of the peer 3421 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3422 * measurement was made) 3423 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3424 * @status: status of the measurement 3425 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3426 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3427 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3428 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3429 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3430 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3431 */ 3432 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3433 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3434 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3435 3436 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3437 3438 u8 final:1, 3439 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3440 3441 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3442 3443 union { 3444 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3445 }; 3446 }; 3447 3448 /** 3449 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3450 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3451 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3452 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3453 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3454 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3455 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3456 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3457 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3458 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3459 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3460 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3461 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3462 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3463 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3464 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3465 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3466 * 3467 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3468 */ 3469 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3470 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3471 u16 burst_period; 3472 u8 requested:1, 3473 asap:1, 3474 request_lci:1, 3475 request_civicloc:1, 3476 trigger_based:1, 3477 non_trigger_based:1; 3478 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3479 u8 burst_duration; 3480 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3481 u8 ftmr_retries; 3482 }; 3483 3484 /** 3485 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 3486 * @addr: MAC address 3487 * @chandef: channel to use 3488 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 3489 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 3490 */ 3491 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 3492 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3493 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3494 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 3495 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 3496 }; 3497 3498 /** 3499 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 3500 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 3501 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 3502 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 3503 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 3504 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 3505 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 3506 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 3507 * be taken from the @mac_addr 3508 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 3509 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 3510 * zero it means there's no timeout 3511 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 3512 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 3513 */ 3514 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 3515 u64 cookie; 3516 void *drv_data; 3517 u32 n_peers; 3518 u32 nl_portid; 3519 3520 u32 timeout; 3521 3522 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3523 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3524 3525 struct list_head list; 3526 3527 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[]; 3528 }; 3529 3530 /** 3531 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 3532 * 3533 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 3534 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 3535 * 3536 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 3537 * 3538 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 3539 * has to be done. 3540 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 3541 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 3542 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 3543 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 3544 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 3545 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 3546 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 3547 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 3548 */ 3549 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 3550 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3551 u16 status; 3552 const u8 *ie; 3553 size_t ie_len; 3554 }; 3555 3556 /** 3557 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 3558 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3559 * for the entire device 3560 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3561 * for the given interface 3562 * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 3563 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 3564 * for these subtypes 3565 */ 3566 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 3567 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 3568 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 3569 }; 3570 3571 /** 3572 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 3573 * 3574 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 3575 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 3576 * 3577 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 3578 * on success or a negative error code. 3579 * 3580 * All operations are currently invoked under rtnl for consistency with the 3581 * wireless extensions but this is subject to reevaluation as soon as this 3582 * code is used more widely and we have a first user without wext. 3583 * 3584 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 3585 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 3586 * configured for the device. 3587 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 3588 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 3589 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 3590 * the device. 3591 * 3592 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 3593 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 3594 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 3595 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 3596 * also set the address member in the wdev. 3597 * 3598 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 3599 * 3600 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 3601 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 3602 * 3603 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 3604 * when adding a group key. 3605 * 3606 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 3607 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 3608 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 3609 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 3610 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 3611 * 3612 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 3613 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. 3614 * 3615 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface 3616 * 3617 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface 3618 * 3619 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface 3620 * 3621 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 3622 * 3623 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 3624 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 3625 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 3626 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 3627 * 3628 * @add_station: Add a new station. 3629 * @del_station: Remove a station 3630 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 3631 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 3632 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 3633 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 3634 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 3635 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 3636 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3637 * 3638 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 3639 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 3640 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 3641 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 3642 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3643 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 3644 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3645 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 3646 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3647 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 3648 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3649 * 3650 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 3651 * 3652 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 3653 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 3654 * set, and which to leave alone. 3655 * 3656 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 3657 * 3658 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 3659 * 3660 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 3661 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 3662 * join the mesh instead. 3663 * 3664 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 3665 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 3666 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 3667 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 3668 * 3669 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 3670 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 3671 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 3672 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 3673 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 3674 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 3675 * 3676 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 3677 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3678 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 3679 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3680 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 3681 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3682 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 3683 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3684 * 3685 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 3686 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 3687 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 3688 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 3689 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 3690 * was received. 3691 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 3692 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 3693 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 3694 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 3695 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 3696 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 3697 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 3698 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 3699 * indication of requesting reassociation. 3700 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 3701 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 3702 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3703 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 3704 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 3705 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 3706 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 3707 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 3708 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 3709 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 3710 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3711 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 3712 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 3713 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 3714 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 3715 * 3716 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 3717 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 3718 * to a merge. 3719 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3720 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 3721 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3722 * 3723 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 3724 * MESH mode) 3725 * 3726 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 3727 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 3728 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 3729 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 3730 * 3731 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 3732 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 3733 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 3734 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 3735 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 3736 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 3737 * return 0 if successful 3738 * 3739 * @set_wds_peer: set the WDS peer for a WDS interface 3740 * 3741 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 3742 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 3743 * 3744 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 3745 * 3746 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 3747 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 3748 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 3749 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 3750 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 3751 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 3752 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 3753 * the duration value. 3754 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 3755 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 3756 * frame on another channel 3757 * 3758 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 3759 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 3760 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 3761 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 3762 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 3763 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 3764 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 3765 * 3766 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 3767 * 3768 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 3769 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 3770 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 3771 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 3772 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 3773 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 3774 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 3775 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 3776 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 3777 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 3778 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 3779 * disabled.) 3780 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 3781 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 3782 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 3783 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 3784 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 3785 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 3786 * thresholds. 3787 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 3788 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 3789 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 3790 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 3791 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 3792 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 3793 * stop (when this method returns 0). 3794 * 3795 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 3796 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 3797 * 3798 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3799 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3800 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3801 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3802 * 3803 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3804 * 3805 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 3806 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 3807 * 3808 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 3809 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 3810 * 3811 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 3812 * 3813 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 3814 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 3815 * current monitoring channel. 3816 * 3817 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 3818 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 3819 * 3820 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 3821 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 3822 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 3823 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 3824 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 3825 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 3826 * 3827 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 3828 * 3829 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 3830 * was finished on another phy. 3831 * 3832 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 3833 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 3834 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 3835 * 3836 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 3837 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 3838 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 3839 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 3840 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 3841 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 3842 * 3843 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 3844 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 3845 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 3846 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 3847 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 3848 * as soon as possible. 3849 * 3850 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 3851 * 3852 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 3853 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 3854 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 3855 * 3856 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 3857 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 3858 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 3859 * account. 3860 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 3861 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 3862 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 3863 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 3864 * rejected) 3865 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 3866 * 3867 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 3868 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3869 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 3870 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3871 * 3872 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 3873 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 3874 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 3875 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 3876 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 3877 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 3878 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 3879 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 3880 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 3881 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 3882 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 3883 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 3884 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 3885 * provided @nan_func. 3886 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 3887 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 3888 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 3889 * All other parameters must be ignored. 3890 * 3891 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 3892 * 3893 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 3894 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 3895 * 3896 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 3897 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 3898 * upon which the driver should clear it. 3899 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3900 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 3901 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3902 * 3903 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 3904 * user space 3905 * 3906 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 3907 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 3908 * 3909 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 3910 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 3911 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 3912 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 3913 * 3914 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 3915 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 3916 * DH IE through this interface. 3917 * 3918 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 3919 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 3920 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 3921 * This callback may sleep. 3922 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 3923 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 3924 */ 3925 struct cfg80211_ops { 3926 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 3927 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 3928 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 3929 3930 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3931 const char *name, 3932 unsigned char name_assign_type, 3933 enum nl80211_iftype type, 3934 struct vif_params *params); 3935 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3936 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 3937 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3938 struct net_device *dev, 3939 enum nl80211_iftype type, 3940 struct vif_params *params); 3941 3942 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3943 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 3944 struct key_params *params); 3945 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3946 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 3947 void *cookie, 3948 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 3949 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 3950 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr); 3951 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3952 struct net_device *netdev, 3953 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 3954 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3955 struct net_device *netdev, 3956 u8 key_index); 3957 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3958 struct net_device *netdev, 3959 u8 key_index); 3960 3961 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3962 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 3963 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3964 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info); 3965 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 3966 3967 3968 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3969 const u8 *mac, 3970 struct station_parameters *params); 3971 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3972 struct station_del_parameters *params); 3973 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3974 const u8 *mac, 3975 struct station_parameters *params); 3976 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3977 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 3978 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3979 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 3980 3981 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3982 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 3983 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3984 const u8 *dst); 3985 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3986 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 3987 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3988 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3989 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3990 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 3991 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3992 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3993 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3994 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 3995 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 3996 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 3997 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3998 struct net_device *dev, 3999 struct mesh_config *conf); 4000 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4001 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4002 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4003 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4004 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4005 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4006 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4007 4008 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4009 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4010 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4011 4012 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4013 struct bss_parameters *params); 4014 4015 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4016 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4017 4018 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4019 struct net_device *dev, 4020 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4021 4022 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4023 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4024 4025 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4026 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4027 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4028 4029 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4030 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4031 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4032 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4033 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4034 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4035 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4036 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4037 4038 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4039 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4040 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4041 struct net_device *dev, 4042 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4043 u32 changed); 4044 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4045 u16 reason_code); 4046 4047 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4048 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4049 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4050 4051 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4052 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4053 4054 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4055 4056 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4057 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4058 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4059 int *dbm); 4060 4061 int (*set_wds_peer)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4062 const u8 *addr); 4063 4064 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4065 4066 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4067 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4068 void *data, int len); 4069 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4070 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4071 void *data, int len); 4072 #endif 4073 4074 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4075 struct net_device *dev, 4076 const u8 *peer, 4077 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4078 4079 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4080 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4081 4082 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4083 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4084 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4085 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4086 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4087 4088 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4089 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4090 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4091 unsigned int duration, 4092 u64 *cookie); 4093 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4094 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4095 u64 cookie); 4096 4097 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4098 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4099 u64 *cookie); 4100 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4101 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4102 u64 cookie); 4103 4104 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4105 bool enabled, int timeout); 4106 4107 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4108 struct net_device *dev, 4109 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4110 4111 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4112 struct net_device *dev, 4113 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4114 4115 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4116 struct net_device *dev, 4117 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4118 4119 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4120 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4121 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4122 4123 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4124 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4125 4126 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4127 struct net_device *dev, 4128 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4129 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4130 u64 reqid); 4131 4132 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4133 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4134 4135 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4136 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, 4137 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability, 4138 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4139 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4140 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4141 4142 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4143 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4144 4145 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4146 struct net_device *dev, 4147 u16 noack_map); 4148 4149 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4150 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4151 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4152 4153 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4154 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4155 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4156 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4157 4158 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4159 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4160 4161 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4162 struct net_device *dev, 4163 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4164 u32 cac_time_ms); 4165 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4166 struct net_device *dev); 4167 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4168 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4169 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4170 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4171 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4172 u16 duration); 4173 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4174 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4175 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4176 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4177 4178 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4179 struct net_device *dev, 4180 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4181 4182 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4183 struct net_device *dev, 4184 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4185 4186 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4187 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4188 4189 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4190 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4191 u16 admitted_time); 4192 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4193 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4194 4195 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4196 struct net_device *dev, 4197 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4198 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4199 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4200 struct net_device *dev, 4201 const u8 *addr); 4202 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4203 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4204 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4205 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4206 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4207 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4208 u64 cookie); 4209 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4210 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4211 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4212 u32 changes); 4213 4214 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4215 struct net_device *dev, 4216 const bool enabled); 4217 4218 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4219 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4220 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4221 4222 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4223 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4224 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4225 const u8 *aa); 4226 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4227 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4228 4229 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4230 struct net_device *dev, 4231 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4232 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4233 const bool noencrypt, 4234 u64 *cookie); 4235 4236 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4237 struct net_device *dev, 4238 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4239 4240 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4241 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4242 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4243 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4244 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4245 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4246 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4247 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4248 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4249 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4250 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4251 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4252 }; 4253 4254 /* 4255 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4256 * and registration/helper functions 4257 */ 4258 4259 /** 4260 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4261 * 4262 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4263 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. 4264 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4265 * wiphy at all 4266 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4267 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4268 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4269 * reason to override the default 4270 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4271 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4272 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4273 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4274 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4275 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4276 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4277 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4278 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4279 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4280 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4281 * firmware. 4282 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4283 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4284 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4285 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4286 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4287 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4288 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4289 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4290 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4291 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4292 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4293 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4294 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4295 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4296 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4297 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4298 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4299 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4300 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation 4301 * before connection. 4302 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4303 */ 4304 enum wiphy_flags { 4305 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4306 /* use hole at 1 */ 4307 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 4308 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4309 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4310 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4311 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4312 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4313 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4314 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4315 /* use hole at 11 */ 4316 /* use hole at 12 */ 4317 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4318 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4319 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4320 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4321 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4322 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4323 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4324 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4325 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4326 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4327 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4328 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24), 4329 }; 4330 4331 /** 4332 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4333 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4334 * @types: interface types (bits) 4335 */ 4336 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4337 u16 max; 4338 u16 types; 4339 }; 4340 4341 /** 4342 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4343 * 4344 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4345 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4346 * 4347 * Examples: 4348 * 4349 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4350 * 4351 * .. code-block:: c 4352 * 4353 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4354 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4355 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, }, 4356 * }; 4357 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4358 * .limits = limits1, 4359 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4360 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4361 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4362 * }; 4363 * 4364 * 4365 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4366 * 4367 * .. code-block:: c 4368 * 4369 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4370 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4371 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4372 * }; 4373 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4374 * .limits = limits2, 4375 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4376 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4377 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4378 * }; 4379 * 4380 * 4381 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4382 * 4383 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4384 * 4385 * .. code-block:: c 4386 * 4387 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 4388 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4389 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 4390 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 4391 * }; 4392 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 4393 * .limits = limits3, 4394 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 4395 * .max_interfaces = 4, 4396 * .num_different_channels = 2, 4397 * }; 4398 * 4399 */ 4400 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 4401 /** 4402 * @limits: 4403 * limits for the given interface types 4404 */ 4405 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 4406 4407 /** 4408 * @num_different_channels: 4409 * can use up to this many different channels 4410 */ 4411 u32 num_different_channels; 4412 4413 /** 4414 * @max_interfaces: 4415 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 4416 */ 4417 u16 max_interfaces; 4418 4419 /** 4420 * @n_limits: 4421 * number of limitations 4422 */ 4423 u8 n_limits; 4424 4425 /** 4426 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 4427 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 4428 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 4429 */ 4430 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 4431 4432 /** 4433 * @radar_detect_widths: 4434 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 4435 */ 4436 u8 radar_detect_widths; 4437 4438 /** 4439 * @radar_detect_regions: 4440 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 4441 */ 4442 u8 radar_detect_regions; 4443 4444 /** 4445 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 4446 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 4447 * 4448 * = 0 4449 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 4450 * > 0 4451 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 4452 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 4453 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 4454 */ 4455 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 4456 }; 4457 4458 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 4459 u16 tx, rx; 4460 }; 4461 4462 /** 4463 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 4464 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 4465 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 4466 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 4467 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 4468 * packet should be preserved in that case 4469 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 4470 * (see nl80211.h) 4471 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 4472 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 4473 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 4474 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 4475 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 4476 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 4477 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 4478 */ 4479 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 4480 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 4481 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 4482 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 4483 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 4484 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 4485 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 4486 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 4487 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 4488 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 4489 }; 4490 4491 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 4492 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 4493 u32 data_payload_max; 4494 u32 data_interval_max; 4495 u32 wake_payload_max; 4496 bool seq; 4497 }; 4498 4499 /** 4500 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 4501 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 4502 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 4503 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4504 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4505 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4506 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4507 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 4508 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 4509 * scheduled scans. 4510 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 4511 * details. 4512 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 4513 */ 4514 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 4515 u32 flags; 4516 int n_patterns; 4517 int pattern_max_len; 4518 int pattern_min_len; 4519 int max_pkt_offset; 4520 int max_nd_match_sets; 4521 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 4522 }; 4523 4524 /** 4525 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 4526 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 4527 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 4528 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 4529 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4530 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4531 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4532 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4533 */ 4534 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 4535 int n_rules; 4536 int max_delay; 4537 int n_patterns; 4538 int pattern_max_len; 4539 int pattern_min_len; 4540 int max_pkt_offset; 4541 }; 4542 4543 /** 4544 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 4545 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 4546 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 4547 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 4548 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 4549 */ 4550 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 4551 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 4552 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 4553 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 4554 }; 4555 4556 /** 4557 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 4558 * 4559 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 4560 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 4561 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 4562 * 4563 */ 4564 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 4565 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 4566 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 4567 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 4568 }; 4569 4570 /** 4571 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 4572 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 4573 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 4574 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 4575 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 4576 */ 4577 4578 struct sta_opmode_info { 4579 u32 changed; 4580 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 4581 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 4582 u8 rx_nss; 4583 }; 4584 4585 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 4586 4587 /** 4588 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 4589 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 4590 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 4591 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 4592 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 4593 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 4594 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 4595 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 4596 * dumpit calls. 4597 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 4598 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 4599 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 4600 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 4601 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 4602 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 4603 * are used with dump requests. 4604 */ 4605 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 4606 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 4607 u32 flags; 4608 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4609 const void *data, int data_len); 4610 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4611 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 4612 unsigned long *storage); 4613 const struct nla_policy *policy; 4614 unsigned int maxattr; 4615 }; 4616 4617 /** 4618 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 4619 * @iftype: interface type 4620 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4621 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 4622 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 4623 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 4624 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 4625 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4626 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4627 */ 4628 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 4629 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 4630 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 4631 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 4632 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4633 }; 4634 4635 /** 4636 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 4637 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 4638 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 4639 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 4640 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 4641 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 4642 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 4643 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 4644 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 4645 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 4646 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 4647 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 4648 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 4649 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 4650 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 4651 * not limited) 4652 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4653 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4654 */ 4655 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 4656 unsigned int max_peers; 4657 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 4658 randomize_mac_addr:1; 4659 4660 struct { 4661 u32 preambles; 4662 u32 bandwidths; 4663 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 4664 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 4665 u8 supported:1, 4666 asap:1, 4667 non_asap:1, 4668 request_lci:1, 4669 request_civicloc:1, 4670 trigger_based:1, 4671 non_trigger_based:1; 4672 } ftm; 4673 }; 4674 4675 /** 4676 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 4677 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 4678 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 4679 * 4680 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 4681 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 4682 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4683 */ 4684 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 4685 u16 iftypes_mask; 4686 const u32 *akm_suites; 4687 int n_akm_suites; 4688 }; 4689 4690 /** 4691 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 4692 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 4693 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 4694 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 4695 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 4696 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 4697 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 4698 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 4699 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 4700 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 4701 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 4702 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 4703 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 4704 * iftype_akm_suites. 4705 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4706 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 4707 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 4708 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 4709 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 4710 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 4711 * suites are specified separately. 4712 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 4713 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 4714 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 4715 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 4716 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 4717 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 4718 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 4719 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 4720 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 4721 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 4722 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 4723 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 4724 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 4725 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 4726 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 4727 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 4728 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 4729 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 4730 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 4731 * unregister hardware 4732 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 4733 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 4734 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 4735 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 4736 * (see below). 4737 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 4738 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 4739 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 4740 * must be set by driver 4741 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 4742 * list single interface types. 4743 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 4744 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 4745 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 4746 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 4747 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 4748 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 4749 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 4750 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 4751 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 4752 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 4753 * this variable determines its size 4754 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 4755 * any given scan 4756 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 4757 * the device can run concurrently. 4758 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 4759 * for in any given scheduled scan 4760 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 4761 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 4762 * supported. 4763 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 4764 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 4765 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 4766 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 4767 * scans 4768 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 4769 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 4770 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 4771 * single scan plan supported by the device. 4772 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 4773 * scan plan supported by the device. 4774 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 4775 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 4776 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 4777 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 4778 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 4779 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 4780 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 4781 * 4782 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 4783 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 4784 * type 4785 * 4786 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4787 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4788 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 4789 * 4790 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4791 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4792 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 4793 * 4794 * @probe_resp_offload: 4795 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 4796 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 4797 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 4798 * 4799 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 4800 * may request, if implemented. 4801 * 4802 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 4803 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 4804 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 4805 * to the suspend() operation instead. 4806 * 4807 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 4808 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 4809 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4810 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 4811 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4812 * 4813 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 4814 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 4815 * 4816 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 4817 * supports for ACL. 4818 * 4819 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4820 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 4821 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 4822 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 4823 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 4824 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 4825 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 4826 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4827 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4828 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 4829 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 4830 * capabilities are specified separately. 4831 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 4832 * 4833 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 4834 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 4835 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 4836 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 4837 * 4838 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 4839 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 4840 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 4841 * some cases, but may not always reach. 4842 * 4843 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 4844 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 4845 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 4846 * infinite. 4847 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 4848 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 4849 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 4850 * 4851 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 4852 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 4853 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 4854 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 4855 * 4856 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 4857 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 4858 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 4859 * 4860 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 4861 * wake_tx_queue 4862 * 4863 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 4864 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 4865 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 4866 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 4867 * 4868 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 4869 * 4870 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 4871 * device has 4872 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4873 * supported by the driver for each vif 4874 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4875 * supported by the driver for each peer 4876 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 4877 * long/short retry configuration 4878 * 4879 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 4880 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 4881 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 4882 */ 4883 struct wiphy { 4884 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 4885 4886 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4887 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 4888 4889 struct mac_address *addresses; 4890 4891 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 4892 4893 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 4894 int n_iface_combinations; 4895 u16 software_iftypes; 4896 4897 u16 n_addresses; 4898 4899 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 4900 u16 interface_modes; 4901 4902 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 4903 4904 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 4905 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 4906 4907 u32 ap_sme_capa; 4908 4909 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 4910 4911 int bss_priv_size; 4912 u8 max_scan_ssids; 4913 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 4914 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 4915 u8 max_match_sets; 4916 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 4917 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 4918 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 4919 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 4920 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 4921 4922 int n_cipher_suites; 4923 const u32 *cipher_suites; 4924 4925 int n_akm_suites; 4926 const u32 *akm_suites; 4927 4928 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 4929 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 4930 4931 u8 retry_short; 4932 u8 retry_long; 4933 u32 frag_threshold; 4934 u32 rts_threshold; 4935 u8 coverage_class; 4936 4937 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 4938 u32 hw_version; 4939 4940 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4941 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 4942 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 4943 #endif 4944 4945 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 4946 4947 u8 max_num_pmkids; 4948 4949 u32 available_antennas_tx; 4950 u32 available_antennas_rx; 4951 4952 u32 probe_resp_offload; 4953 4954 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 4955 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4956 4957 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 4958 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 4959 4960 const void *privid; 4961 4962 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 4963 4964 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4965 struct regulatory_request *request); 4966 4967 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 4968 4969 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 4970 4971 struct device dev; 4972 4973 bool registered; 4974 4975 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 4976 4977 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 4978 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 4979 4980 struct list_head wdev_list; 4981 4982 possible_net_t _net; 4983 4984 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 4985 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 4986 #endif 4987 4988 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 4989 4990 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 4991 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 4992 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 4993 4994 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 4995 4996 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 4997 4998 u32 bss_select_support; 4999 5000 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5001 5002 u32 txq_limit; 5003 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5004 u32 txq_quantum; 5005 5006 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5007 5008 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5009 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5010 5011 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5012 5013 struct { 5014 u64 peer, vif; 5015 u8 max_retry; 5016 } tid_config_support; 5017 5018 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5019 5020 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5021 }; 5022 5023 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5024 { 5025 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5026 } 5027 5028 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5029 { 5030 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5031 } 5032 5033 /** 5034 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5035 * 5036 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5037 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5038 */ 5039 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5040 { 5041 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5042 return &wiphy->priv; 5043 } 5044 5045 /** 5046 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5047 * 5048 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5049 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5050 */ 5051 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5052 { 5053 BUG_ON(!priv); 5054 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5055 } 5056 5057 /** 5058 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5059 * 5060 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5061 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5062 */ 5063 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5064 { 5065 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5066 } 5067 5068 /** 5069 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5070 * 5071 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5072 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5073 */ 5074 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5075 { 5076 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5077 } 5078 5079 /** 5080 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5081 * 5082 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5083 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5084 */ 5085 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5086 { 5087 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5088 } 5089 5090 /** 5091 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5092 * 5093 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5094 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5095 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5096 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5097 * 5098 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5099 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5100 * 5101 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5102 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5103 */ 5104 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5105 const char *requested_name); 5106 5107 /** 5108 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5109 * 5110 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5111 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5112 * 5113 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5114 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5115 * 5116 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5117 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5118 */ 5119 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5120 int sizeof_priv) 5121 { 5122 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5123 } 5124 5125 /** 5126 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5127 * 5128 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5129 * 5130 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5131 */ 5132 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5133 5134 /** 5135 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5136 * 5137 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5138 * 5139 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5140 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5141 * request that is being handled. 5142 */ 5143 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5144 5145 /** 5146 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5147 * 5148 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5149 */ 5150 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5151 5152 /* internal structs */ 5153 struct cfg80211_conn; 5154 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5155 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5156 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5157 5158 /** 5159 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5160 * 5161 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5162 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5163 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5164 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5165 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device. 5166 * 5167 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 5168 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 5169 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 5170 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 5171 * 5172 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 5173 * @iftype: interface type 5174 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 5175 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 5176 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 5177 * wireless device if it has no netdev 5178 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5179 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track 5180 * the user-set channel definition. 5181 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to 5182 * track the channel to be used for AP later 5183 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5184 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5185 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5186 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5187 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5188 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 5189 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 5190 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 5191 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 5192 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 5193 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 5194 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 5195 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 5196 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 5197 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 5198 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 5199 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 5200 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 5201 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 5202 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 5203 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 5204 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 5205 * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list 5206 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 5207 * need to propagate the update to the driver 5208 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers 5209 * and some API functions require it held 5210 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 5211 * beacons, 0 when not valid 5212 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 5213 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 5214 * the P2P Device. 5215 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 5216 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 5217 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 5218 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 5219 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 5220 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 5221 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 5222 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 5223 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 5224 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 5225 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 5226 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 5227 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 5228 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID 5229 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel 5230 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 5231 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 5232 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 5233 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 5234 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 5235 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 5236 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 5237 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 5238 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 5239 * unprotected beacon report 5240 */ 5241 struct wireless_dev { 5242 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5243 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5244 5245 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 5246 struct list_head list; 5247 struct net_device *netdev; 5248 5249 u32 identifier; 5250 5251 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 5252 spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock; 5253 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 5254 5255 struct mutex mtx; 5256 5257 bool use_4addr, is_running; 5258 5259 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 5260 5261 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 5262 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5263 u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len; 5264 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 5265 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 5266 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 5267 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 5268 5269 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 5270 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5271 5272 struct list_head event_list; 5273 spinlock_t event_lock; 5274 5275 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */ 5276 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 5277 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 5278 5279 bool ibss_fixed; 5280 bool ibss_dfs_possible; 5281 5282 bool ps; 5283 int ps_timeout; 5284 5285 int beacon_interval; 5286 5287 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 5288 5289 u32 owner_nlportid; 5290 bool nl_owner_dead; 5291 5292 bool cac_started; 5293 unsigned long cac_start_time; 5294 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 5295 5296 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5297 /* wext data */ 5298 struct { 5299 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 5300 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 5301 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 5302 const u8 *ie; 5303 size_t ie_len; 5304 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5305 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5306 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5307 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 5308 bool prev_bssid_valid; 5309 } wext; 5310 #endif 5311 5312 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config; 5313 5314 struct list_head pmsr_list; 5315 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 5316 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 5317 5318 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 5319 }; 5320 5321 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5322 { 5323 if (wdev->netdev) 5324 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 5325 return wdev->address; 5326 } 5327 5328 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5329 { 5330 if (wdev->netdev) 5331 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 5332 return wdev->is_running; 5333 } 5334 5335 /** 5336 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 5337 * 5338 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 5339 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 5340 */ 5341 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5342 { 5343 BUG_ON(!wdev); 5344 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 5345 } 5346 5347 /** 5348 * DOC: Utility functions 5349 * 5350 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 5351 */ 5352 5353 /** 5354 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 5355 * 5356 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 5357 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 5358 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 5359 */ 5360 static inline bool 5361 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 5362 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 5363 { 5364 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 5365 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 5366 } 5367 5368 /** 5369 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 5370 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 5371 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 5372 */ 5373 static inline u32 5374 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5375 { 5376 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 5377 } 5378 5379 /** 5380 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 5381 * 5382 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 5383 * @chan: channel 5384 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 5385 */ 5386 enum nl80211_chan_width 5387 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 5388 5389 /** 5390 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 5391 * @chan: channel number 5392 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5393 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5394 */ 5395 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 5396 5397 /** 5398 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 5399 * @chan: channel number 5400 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5401 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5402 */ 5403 static inline int 5404 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 5405 { 5406 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 5407 } 5408 5409 /** 5410 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5411 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 5412 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5413 */ 5414 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 5415 5416 /** 5417 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5418 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 5419 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5420 */ 5421 static inline int 5422 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 5423 { 5424 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5425 } 5426 5427 /** 5428 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 5429 * frequency 5430 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5431 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 5432 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5433 */ 5434 struct ieee80211_channel * 5435 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 5436 5437 /** 5438 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 5439 * 5440 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5441 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 5442 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5443 */ 5444 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 5445 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 5446 { 5447 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5448 } 5449 5450 /** 5451 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 5452 * @chan: control channel to check 5453 * 5454 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 5455 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 5456 */ 5457 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5458 { 5459 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 5460 return false; 5461 5462 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 5463 } 5464 5465 /** 5466 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 5467 * 5468 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5469 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 5470 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 5471 * 5472 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 5473 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 5474 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 5475 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 5476 */ 5477 struct ieee80211_rate * 5478 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5479 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 5480 5481 /** 5482 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 5483 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5484 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 5485 * 5486 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 5487 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 5488 */ 5489 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5490 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width); 5491 5492 /* 5493 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 5494 * 5495 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 5496 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 5497 */ 5498 5499 struct radiotap_align_size { 5500 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 5501 }; 5502 5503 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 5504 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 5505 int n_bits; 5506 uint32_t oui; 5507 uint8_t subns; 5508 }; 5509 5510 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 5511 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 5512 int n_ns; 5513 }; 5514 5515 /** 5516 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 5517 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 5518 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 5519 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 5520 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 5521 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 5522 * the beginning of the actual data portion 5523 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 5524 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 5525 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 5526 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 5527 * radiotap namespace or not 5528 * 5529 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 5530 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 5531 * @_arg_index: next argument index 5532 * @_arg: next argument pointer 5533 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 5534 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 5535 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 5536 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 5537 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 5538 * next bitmap word 5539 * 5540 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 5541 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 5542 */ 5543 5544 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 5545 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 5546 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 5547 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 5548 5549 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 5550 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 5551 5552 unsigned char *this_arg; 5553 int this_arg_index; 5554 int this_arg_size; 5555 5556 int is_radiotap_ns; 5557 5558 int _max_length; 5559 int _arg_index; 5560 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 5561 int _reset_on_ext; 5562 }; 5563 5564 int 5565 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 5566 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 5567 int max_length, 5568 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 5569 5570 int 5571 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 5572 5573 5574 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 5575 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 5576 5577 /** 5578 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 5579 * 5580 * @skb: the frame 5581 * 5582 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 5583 * returns the 802.11 header length. 5584 * 5585 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 5586 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 5587 * 802.11 header. 5588 */ 5589 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 5590 5591 /** 5592 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 5593 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 5594 * Return: The header length in bytes. 5595 */ 5596 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 5597 5598 /** 5599 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 5600 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 5601 * (first byte) will be accessed 5602 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 5603 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 5604 */ 5605 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 5606 5607 /** 5608 * DOC: Data path helpers 5609 * 5610 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 5611 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 5612 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 5613 */ 5614 5615 /** 5616 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5617 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5618 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 5619 * of it being pushed into the SKB 5620 * @addr: the device MAC address 5621 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5622 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 5623 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5624 */ 5625 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 5626 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5627 u8 data_offset); 5628 5629 /** 5630 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5631 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5632 * @addr: the device MAC address 5633 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5634 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5635 */ 5636 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 5637 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 5638 { 5639 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0); 5640 } 5641 5642 /** 5643 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 5644 * 5645 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 5646 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 5647 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 5648 * 5649 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 5650 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 5651 * initialized by the caller. 5652 * @addr: The device MAC address. 5653 * @iftype: The device interface type. 5654 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 5655 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5656 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5657 */ 5658 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 5659 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5660 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 5661 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa); 5662 5663 /** 5664 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 5665 * @skb: the data frame 5666 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 5667 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 5668 */ 5669 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 5670 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 5671 5672 /** 5673 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 5674 * 5675 * @eid: element ID 5676 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5677 * @len: length of data 5678 * @match: byte array to match 5679 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5680 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 5681 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 5682 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 5683 * the data portion instead. 5684 * 5685 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5686 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5687 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5688 * requested element struct. 5689 * 5690 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5691 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5692 * byte array to match. 5693 */ 5694 const struct element * 5695 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5696 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5697 unsigned int match_offset); 5698 5699 /** 5700 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 5701 * 5702 * @eid: element ID 5703 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5704 * @len: length of data 5705 * @match: byte array to match 5706 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5707 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 5708 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 5709 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 5710 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 5711 * the second byte is the IE length. 5712 * 5713 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5714 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5715 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 5716 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5717 * element ID. 5718 * 5719 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5720 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5721 * byte array to match. 5722 */ 5723 static inline const u8 * 5724 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5725 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5726 unsigned int match_offset) 5727 { 5728 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 5729 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 5730 */ 5731 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 5732 (!match_len && match_offset))) 5733 return NULL; 5734 5735 return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 5736 match, match_len, 5737 match_offset ? 5738 match_offset - 2 : 0); 5739 } 5740 5741 /** 5742 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 5743 * 5744 * @eid: element ID 5745 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5746 * @len: length of data 5747 * 5748 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5749 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5750 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5751 * requested element struct. 5752 * 5753 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5754 * having to fit into the given data. 5755 */ 5756 static inline const struct element * 5757 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5758 { 5759 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5760 } 5761 5762 /** 5763 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 5764 * 5765 * @eid: element ID 5766 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5767 * @len: length of data 5768 * 5769 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5770 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5771 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5772 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5773 * 5774 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5775 * having to fit into the given data. 5776 */ 5777 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5778 { 5779 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5780 } 5781 5782 /** 5783 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 5784 * 5785 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5786 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5787 * @len: length of data 5788 * 5789 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if 5790 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5791 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5792 * requested element struct. 5793 * 5794 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5795 * having to fit into the given data. 5796 */ 5797 static inline const struct element * 5798 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5799 { 5800 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5801 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 5802 } 5803 5804 /** 5805 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 5806 * 5807 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5808 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5809 * @len: length of data 5810 * 5811 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 5812 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5813 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5814 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5815 * 5816 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5817 * having to fit into the given data. 5818 */ 5819 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5820 { 5821 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5822 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 5823 } 5824 5825 /** 5826 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 5827 * 5828 * @oui: vendor OUI 5829 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5830 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5831 * @len: length of data 5832 * 5833 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5834 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 5835 * return the element structure for the requested element. 5836 * 5837 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5838 * the given data. 5839 */ 5840 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5841 const u8 *ies, 5842 unsigned int len); 5843 5844 /** 5845 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 5846 * 5847 * @oui: vendor OUI 5848 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5849 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5850 * @len: length of data 5851 * 5852 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5853 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 5854 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5855 * element ID. 5856 * 5857 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5858 * the given data. 5859 */ 5860 static inline const u8 * 5861 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5862 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 5863 { 5864 return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 5865 } 5866 5867 /** 5868 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 5869 * 5870 * @dev: network device 5871 * @addr: STA MAC address 5872 * 5873 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 5874 * devices upon STA association. 5875 */ 5876 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 5877 5878 /** 5879 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 5880 * 5881 * TODO 5882 */ 5883 5884 /** 5885 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 5886 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 5887 * conflicts) 5888 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 5889 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 5890 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 5891 * alpha2. 5892 * 5893 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 5894 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 5895 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 5896 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 5897 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 5898 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 5899 * 5900 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 5901 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 5902 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 5903 * 5904 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 5905 * an -ENOMEM. 5906 * 5907 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 5908 */ 5909 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 5910 5911 /** 5912 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 5913 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5914 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy 5915 * 5916 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 5917 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 5918 * information. 5919 * 5920 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 5921 */ 5922 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5923 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 5924 5925 /** 5926 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl - set regdom for self-managed drivers 5927 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5928 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 5929 * 5930 * This functions requires the RTNL to be held and applies the new regdomain 5931 * synchronously to this wiphy. For more details see 5932 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 5933 * 5934 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 5935 */ 5936 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5937 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 5938 5939 /** 5940 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 5941 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 5942 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 5943 * 5944 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 5945 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 5946 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 5947 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 5948 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 5949 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 5950 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 5951 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 5952 * that called this helper. 5953 */ 5954 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5955 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 5956 5957 /** 5958 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 5959 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 5960 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 5961 * 5962 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 5963 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 5964 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 5965 * and processed already. 5966 * 5967 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 5968 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 5969 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 5970 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 5971 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 5972 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 5973 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 5974 */ 5975 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5976 u32 center_freq); 5977 5978 /** 5979 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 5980 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 5981 * 5982 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 5983 * proper string representation. 5984 */ 5985 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 5986 5987 /** 5988 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 5989 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 5990 * 5991 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 5992 */ 5993 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5994 5995 /** 5996 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 5997 * 5998 */ 5999 6000 /** 6001 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 6002 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 6003 * 6004 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 6005 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried. 6006 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 6007 * 6008 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 6009 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 6010 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 6011 * 6012 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6013 * an -ENODATA. 6014 * 6015 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 6016 */ 6017 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 6018 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 6019 6020 /* 6021 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 6022 * functions and BSS handling helpers 6023 */ 6024 6025 /** 6026 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 6027 * 6028 * @request: the corresponding scan request 6029 * @info: information about the completed scan 6030 */ 6031 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 6032 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6033 6034 /** 6035 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 6036 * 6037 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 6038 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6039 */ 6040 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6041 6042 /** 6043 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6044 * 6045 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6046 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6047 * 6048 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6049 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6050 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6051 */ 6052 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6053 6054 /** 6055 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6056 * 6057 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6058 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6059 * 6060 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6061 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6062 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6063 * This function should be called with rtnl locked. 6064 */ 6065 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_rtnl(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6066 6067 /** 6068 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 6069 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6070 * @data: the BSS metadata 6071 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 6072 * @len: length of the management frame 6073 * @gfp: context flags 6074 * 6075 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6076 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6077 * 6078 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6079 * Or %NULL on error. 6080 */ 6081 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6082 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6083 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6084 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6085 gfp_t gfp); 6086 6087 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6088 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6089 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6090 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6091 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6092 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6093 { 6094 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6095 .chan = rx_channel, 6096 .scan_width = scan_width, 6097 .signal = signal, 6098 }; 6099 6100 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6101 } 6102 6103 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6104 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6105 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6106 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6107 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6108 { 6109 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6110 .chan = rx_channel, 6111 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6112 .signal = signal, 6113 }; 6114 6115 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6116 } 6117 6118 /** 6119 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 6120 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 6121 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 6122 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 6123 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 6124 */ 6125 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 6126 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 6127 { 6128 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 6129 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 6130 u64 new_bssid_u64; 6131 6132 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 6133 6134 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 6135 6136 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 6137 } 6138 6139 /** 6140 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 6141 * @element: element to check 6142 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 6143 */ 6144 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 6145 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 6146 6147 /** 6148 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 6149 * @ie: ies 6150 * @ielen: length of IEs 6151 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 6152 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 6153 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 6154 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 6155 */ 6156 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6157 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 6158 const struct element *sub_elem, 6159 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 6160 6161 /** 6162 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 6163 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 6164 * from a beacon or probe response 6165 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 6166 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 6167 */ 6168 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 6169 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 6170 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 6171 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 6172 }; 6173 6174 /** 6175 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 6176 * 6177 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6178 * @data: the BSS metadata 6179 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 6180 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 6181 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 6182 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 6183 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 6184 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 6185 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 6186 * @gfp: context flags 6187 * 6188 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6189 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6190 * 6191 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6192 * Or %NULL on error. 6193 */ 6194 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6195 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6196 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6197 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6198 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6199 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6200 gfp_t gfp); 6201 6202 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6203 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6204 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6205 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6206 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6207 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6208 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6209 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6210 { 6211 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6212 .chan = rx_channel, 6213 .scan_width = scan_width, 6214 .signal = signal, 6215 }; 6216 6217 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6218 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6219 gfp); 6220 } 6221 6222 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6223 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6224 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6225 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6226 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6227 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6228 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6229 { 6230 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6231 .chan = rx_channel, 6232 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6233 .signal = signal, 6234 }; 6235 6236 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6237 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6238 gfp); 6239 } 6240 6241 /** 6242 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 6243 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6244 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 6245 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 6246 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 6247 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 6248 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 6249 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 6250 */ 6251 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6252 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6253 const u8 *bssid, 6254 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 6255 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 6256 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 6257 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 6258 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6259 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6260 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 6261 { 6262 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 6263 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 6264 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 6265 } 6266 6267 /** 6268 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 6269 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6270 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 6271 * 6272 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6273 */ 6274 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6275 6276 /** 6277 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 6278 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6279 * @bss: the BSS struct 6280 * 6281 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6282 */ 6283 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6284 6285 /** 6286 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 6287 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6288 * @bss: the bss to remove 6289 * 6290 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 6291 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 6292 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 6293 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 6294 */ 6295 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6296 6297 /** 6298 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 6299 * 6300 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 6301 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 6302 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 6303 * 6304 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6305 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 6306 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 6307 * @iter: the iterator function to call 6308 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 6309 */ 6310 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6311 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6312 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6313 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6314 void *data), 6315 void *iter_data); 6316 6317 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width 6318 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 6319 { 6320 switch (chandef->width) { 6321 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 6322 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5; 6323 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 6324 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10; 6325 default: 6326 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6327 } 6328 } 6329 6330 /** 6331 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 6332 * @dev: network device 6333 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 6334 * @len: length of the frame data 6335 * 6336 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 6337 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 6338 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 6339 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6340 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6341 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6342 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 6343 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 6344 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 6345 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 6346 * 6347 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6348 */ 6349 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6350 6351 /** 6352 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 6353 * @dev: network device 6354 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 6355 * 6356 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 6357 * mutex. 6358 */ 6359 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6360 6361 /** 6362 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 6363 * @dev: network device 6364 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 6365 * moves to cfg80211 in this call 6366 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 6367 * @len: length of the frame data 6368 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 6369 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 6370 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 6371 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 6372 * 6373 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6374 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6375 * 6376 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6377 */ 6378 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 6379 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6380 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6381 int uapsd_queues, 6382 const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len); 6383 6384 /** 6385 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association 6386 * @dev: network device 6387 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out. 6388 * 6389 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6390 */ 6391 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6392 6393 /** 6394 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt 6395 * @dev: network device 6396 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned. 6397 * 6398 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX, 6399 * an association attempt was abandoned. 6400 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6401 */ 6402 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6403 6404 /** 6405 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 6406 * @dev: network device 6407 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 6408 * @len: length of the frame data 6409 * 6410 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 6411 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 6412 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 6413 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 6414 */ 6415 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6416 6417 /** 6418 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 6419 * @dev: network device 6420 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 6421 * @len: length of the frame data 6422 * 6423 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 6424 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 6425 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 6426 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 6427 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 6428 * 6429 * This function may sleep. 6430 */ 6431 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 6432 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6433 6434 /** 6435 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 6436 * @dev: network device 6437 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 6438 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 6439 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 6440 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 6441 * @gfp: allocation flags 6442 * 6443 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 6444 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 6445 * primitive. 6446 */ 6447 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 6448 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 6449 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 6450 6451 /** 6452 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 6453 * 6454 * @dev: network device 6455 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 6456 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 6457 * @gfp: allocation flags 6458 * 6459 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 6460 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 6461 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 6462 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 6463 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 6464 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 6465 */ 6466 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6467 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 6468 6469 /** 6470 * cfg80211_notify_new_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer candidate 6471 * 6472 * @dev: network device 6473 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 6474 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 6475 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 6476 * @gfp: allocation flags 6477 * 6478 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 6479 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 6480 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 6481 */ 6482 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 6483 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 6484 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 6485 6486 /** 6487 * DOC: RFkill integration 6488 * 6489 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 6490 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 6491 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 6492 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 6493 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 6494 * 6495 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 6496 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 6497 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 6498 */ 6499 6500 /** 6501 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 6502 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6503 * @blocked: block status 6504 */ 6505 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked); 6506 6507 /** 6508 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 6509 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6510 */ 6511 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6512 6513 /** 6514 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 6515 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6516 */ 6517 void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6518 6519 /** 6520 * DOC: Vendor commands 6521 * 6522 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 6523 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 6524 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 6525 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 6526 * the configuration mechanism. 6527 * 6528 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 6529 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 6530 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 6531 * 6532 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 6533 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 6534 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 6535 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 6536 * managers etc. need. 6537 */ 6538 6539 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6540 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6541 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6542 int approxlen); 6543 6544 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6545 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6546 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6547 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6548 unsigned int portid, 6549 int vendor_event_idx, 6550 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 6551 6552 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 6553 6554 /** 6555 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 6556 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6557 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6558 * be put into the skb 6559 * 6560 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6561 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6562 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 6563 * 6564 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 6565 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6566 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6567 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6568 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6569 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 6570 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 6571 * 6572 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 6573 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 6574 * 6575 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6576 */ 6577 static inline struct sk_buff * 6578 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6579 { 6580 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6581 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 6582 } 6583 6584 /** 6585 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 6586 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6587 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 6588 * 6589 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6590 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 6591 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 6592 * skb regardless of the return value. 6593 * 6594 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6595 */ 6596 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 6597 6598 /** 6599 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender 6600 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6601 * 6602 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 6603 * Valid to call only there. 6604 */ 6605 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6606 6607 /** 6608 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 6609 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6610 * @wdev: the wireless device 6611 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6612 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6613 * be put into the skb 6614 * @gfp: allocation flags 6615 * 6616 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6617 * vendor-specific multicast group. 6618 * 6619 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6620 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6621 * attribute. 6622 * 6623 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6624 * skb to send the event. 6625 * 6626 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6627 */ 6628 static inline struct sk_buff * 6629 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6630 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6631 { 6632 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6633 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6634 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6635 } 6636 6637 /** 6638 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 6639 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6640 * @wdev: the wireless device 6641 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6642 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 6643 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6644 * be put into the skb 6645 * @gfp: allocation flags 6646 * 6647 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 6648 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 6649 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 6650 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 6651 * 6652 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6653 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6654 * attribute. 6655 * 6656 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6657 * skb to send the event. 6658 * 6659 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6660 */ 6661 static inline struct sk_buff * 6662 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6663 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6664 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 6665 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6666 { 6667 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6668 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6669 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6670 } 6671 6672 /** 6673 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 6674 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 6675 * @gfp: allocation flags 6676 * 6677 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6678 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 6679 */ 6680 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6681 { 6682 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6683 } 6684 6685 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 6686 /** 6687 * DOC: Test mode 6688 * 6689 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 6690 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 6691 * factory programming. 6692 * 6693 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 6694 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 6695 */ 6696 6697 /** 6698 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 6699 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6700 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6701 * be put into the skb 6702 * 6703 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6704 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6705 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 6706 * 6707 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 6708 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6709 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6710 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6711 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6712 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 6713 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 6714 * 6715 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 6716 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 6717 * 6718 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6719 */ 6720 static inline struct sk_buff * 6721 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6722 { 6723 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6724 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 6725 } 6726 6727 /** 6728 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 6729 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6730 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 6731 * 6732 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6733 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 6734 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 6735 * regardless of the return value. 6736 * 6737 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6738 */ 6739 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 6740 { 6741 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 6742 } 6743 6744 /** 6745 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 6746 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6747 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6748 * be put into the skb 6749 * @gfp: allocation flags 6750 * 6751 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6752 * testmode multicast group. 6753 * 6754 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 6755 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 6756 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 6757 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 6758 * in any other way. 6759 * 6760 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 6761 * skb to send the event. 6762 * 6763 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6764 */ 6765 static inline struct sk_buff * 6766 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 6767 { 6768 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6769 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 6770 approxlen, gfp); 6771 } 6772 6773 /** 6774 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 6775 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6776 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 6777 * @gfp: allocation flags 6778 * 6779 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6780 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 6781 * consumes it. 6782 */ 6783 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6784 { 6785 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6786 } 6787 6788 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 6789 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 6790 #else 6791 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 6792 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 6793 #endif 6794 6795 /** 6796 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 6797 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 6798 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 6799 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 6800 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 6801 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 6802 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 6803 * status for a FILS connection. 6804 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6805 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 6806 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 6807 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6808 */ 6809 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 6810 const u8 *kek; 6811 size_t kek_len; 6812 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 6813 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 6814 const u8 *pmk; 6815 size_t pmk_len; 6816 const u8 *pmkid; 6817 }; 6818 6819 /** 6820 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 6821 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6822 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6823 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6824 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6825 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6826 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6827 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6828 * case. 6829 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL) 6830 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6831 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6832 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6833 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6834 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6835 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6836 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 6837 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 6838 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6839 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 6840 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 6841 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 6842 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 6843 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 6844 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 6845 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 6846 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 6847 */ 6848 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 6849 int status; 6850 const u8 *bssid; 6851 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 6852 const u8 *req_ie; 6853 size_t req_ie_len; 6854 const u8 *resp_ie; 6855 size_t resp_ie_len; 6856 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 6857 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 6858 }; 6859 6860 /** 6861 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6862 * 6863 * @dev: network device 6864 * @params: connection response parameters 6865 * @gfp: allocation flags 6866 * 6867 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6868 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6869 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 6870 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 6871 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 6872 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6873 */ 6874 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 6875 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 6876 gfp_t gfp); 6877 6878 /** 6879 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6880 * 6881 * @dev: network device 6882 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6883 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6884 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6885 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6886 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6887 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6888 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6889 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6890 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6891 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6892 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 6893 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6894 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6895 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6896 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6897 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6898 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6899 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6900 * case. 6901 * @gfp: allocation flags 6902 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 6903 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 6904 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 6905 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 6906 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 6907 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 6908 * 6909 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6910 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6911 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 6912 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 6913 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6914 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6915 */ 6916 static inline void 6917 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6918 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 6919 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 6920 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 6921 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 6922 { 6923 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 6924 6925 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 6926 params.status = status; 6927 params.bssid = bssid; 6928 params.bss = bss; 6929 params.req_ie = req_ie; 6930 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 6931 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 6932 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 6933 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 6934 6935 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 6936 } 6937 6938 /** 6939 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 6940 * 6941 * @dev: network device 6942 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6943 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6944 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6945 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6946 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 6947 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6948 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6949 * the real status code for failures. 6950 * @gfp: allocation flags 6951 * 6952 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 6953 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 6954 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 6955 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6956 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6957 */ 6958 static inline void 6959 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6960 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 6961 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 6962 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 6963 { 6964 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 6965 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 6966 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 6967 } 6968 6969 /** 6970 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 6971 * 6972 * @dev: network device 6973 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 6974 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 6975 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 6976 * @gfp: allocation flags 6977 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 6978 * 6979 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 6980 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 6981 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 6982 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 6983 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 6984 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 6985 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 6986 */ 6987 static inline void 6988 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6989 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 6990 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 6991 { 6992 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 6993 gfp, timeout_reason); 6994 } 6995 6996 /** 6997 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 6998 * 6999 * @channel: the channel of the new AP 7000 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set) 7001 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set) 7002 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7003 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7004 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7005 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7006 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 7007 */ 7008 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 7009 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 7010 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7011 const u8 *bssid; 7012 const u8 *req_ie; 7013 size_t req_ie_len; 7014 const u8 *resp_ie; 7015 size_t resp_ie_len; 7016 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7017 }; 7018 7019 /** 7020 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 7021 * 7022 * @dev: network device 7023 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 7024 * @gfp: allocation flags 7025 * 7026 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 7027 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 7028 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 7029 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 7030 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 7031 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 7032 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 7033 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 7034 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 7035 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 7036 */ 7037 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 7038 gfp_t gfp); 7039 7040 /** 7041 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 7042 * 7043 * @dev: network device 7044 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7045 * @gfp: allocation flags 7046 * 7047 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 7048 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 7049 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 7050 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 7051 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 7052 * indicate the 802.11 association. 7053 */ 7054 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7055 gfp_t gfp); 7056 7057 /** 7058 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 7059 * 7060 * @dev: network device 7061 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 7062 * @ie_len: length of IEs 7063 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 7064 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 7065 * @gfp: allocation flags 7066 * 7067 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 7068 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 7069 */ 7070 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 7071 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 7072 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 7073 7074 /** 7075 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 7076 * @wdev: wireless device 7077 * @cookie: the request cookie 7078 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7079 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 7080 * channel 7081 * @gfp: allocation flags 7082 */ 7083 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7084 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7085 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 7086 7087 /** 7088 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 7089 * @wdev: wireless device 7090 * @cookie: the request cookie 7091 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7092 * @gfp: allocation flags 7093 */ 7094 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7095 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7096 gfp_t gfp); 7097 7098 /** 7099 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 7100 * @wdev: wireless device 7101 * @cookie: the requested cookie 7102 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 7103 * @gfp: allocation flags 7104 */ 7105 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7106 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 7107 7108 /** 7109 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 7110 * 7111 * @sinfo: the station information 7112 * @gfp: allocation flags 7113 */ 7114 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7115 7116 /** 7117 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 7118 * @sinfo: the station information 7119 * 7120 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 7121 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 7122 * the stack.) 7123 */ 7124 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 7125 { 7126 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 7127 } 7128 7129 /** 7130 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 7131 * 7132 * @dev: the netdev 7133 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7134 * @sinfo: the station information 7135 * @gfp: allocation flags 7136 */ 7137 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7138 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7139 7140 /** 7141 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7142 * @dev: the netdev 7143 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7144 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 7145 * @gfp: allocation flags 7146 */ 7147 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7148 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7149 7150 /** 7151 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7152 * 7153 * @dev: the netdev 7154 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7155 * @gfp: allocation flags 7156 */ 7157 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 7158 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 7159 { 7160 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 7161 } 7162 7163 /** 7164 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 7165 * 7166 * @dev: the netdev 7167 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7168 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 7169 * @gfp: allocation flags 7170 * 7171 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 7172 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 7173 * for some reasons, this function is called. 7174 * 7175 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 7176 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 7177 */ 7178 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7179 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 7180 gfp_t gfp); 7181 7182 /** 7183 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7184 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7185 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 7186 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7187 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7188 * @len: length of the frame data 7189 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7190 * 7191 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7192 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7193 * 7194 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7195 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7196 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7197 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7198 */ 7199 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm, 7200 const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags); 7201 7202 /** 7203 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7204 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7205 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 7206 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7207 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7208 * @len: length of the frame data 7209 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7210 * 7211 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7212 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7213 * 7214 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7215 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7216 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7217 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7218 */ 7219 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 7220 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7221 u32 flags) 7222 { 7223 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len, 7224 flags); 7225 } 7226 7227 /** 7228 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 7229 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7230 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 7231 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7232 * @len: length of the frame data 7233 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7234 * @gfp: context flags 7235 * 7236 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 7237 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 7238 * transmission attempt. 7239 */ 7240 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7241 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp); 7242 7243 /** 7244 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 7245 * port frames 7246 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7247 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 7248 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 7249 * @len: length of the frame data 7250 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7251 * @gfp: context flags 7252 * 7253 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 7254 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 7255 * the transmission attempt. 7256 */ 7257 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7258 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 7259 gfp_t gfp); 7260 7261 /** 7262 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 7263 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7264 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 7265 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 7266 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 7267 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 7268 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 7269 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 7270 * 7271 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 7272 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 7273 * control port frames over nl80211. 7274 * 7275 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 7276 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 7277 * 7278 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 7279 */ 7280 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, 7281 struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted); 7282 7283 /** 7284 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 7285 * @dev: network device 7286 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 7287 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 7288 * @gfp: context flags 7289 * 7290 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 7291 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 7292 */ 7293 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7294 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 7295 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 7296 7297 /** 7298 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 7299 * @dev: network device 7300 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7301 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 7302 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 7303 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 7304 * @gfp: context flags 7305 */ 7306 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7307 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 7308 7309 /** 7310 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 7311 * @dev: network device 7312 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7313 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 7314 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 7315 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 7316 * @gfp: context flags 7317 * 7318 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 7319 * given interval is exceeded. 7320 */ 7321 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7322 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 7323 7324 /** 7325 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 7326 * @dev: network device 7327 * @gfp: context flags 7328 * 7329 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 7330 */ 7331 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 7332 7333 /** 7334 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 7335 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7336 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7337 * @gfp: context flags 7338 * 7339 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 7340 */ 7341 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7342 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp); 7343 7344 /** 7345 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 7346 * @dev: network device 7347 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 7348 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 7349 * @gfp: context flags 7350 * 7351 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 7352 * frame. 7353 */ 7354 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 7355 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 7356 gfp_t gfp); 7357 7358 /** 7359 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 7360 * @netdev: network device 7361 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7362 * @event: type of event 7363 * @gfp: context flags 7364 * 7365 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 7366 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 7367 * also by full-MAC drivers. 7368 */ 7369 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7370 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7371 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 7372 7373 7374 /** 7375 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 7376 * @dev: network device 7377 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 7378 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 7379 * @gfp: allocation flags 7380 */ 7381 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7382 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 7383 7384 /** 7385 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 7386 * @dev: network device 7387 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 7388 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 7389 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 7390 * @gfp: allocation flags 7391 */ 7392 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 7393 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 7394 7395 /** 7396 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 7397 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7398 * @addr: the transmitter address 7399 * @gfp: context flags 7400 * 7401 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7402 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 7403 * sender. 7404 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7405 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7406 */ 7407 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7408 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7409 7410 /** 7411 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 7412 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7413 * @addr: the transmitter address 7414 * @gfp: context flags 7415 * 7416 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7417 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 7418 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 7419 * station to avoid event flooding. 7420 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7421 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7422 */ 7423 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7424 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7425 7426 /** 7427 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 7428 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 7429 * @addr: the address of the peer 7430 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 7431 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 7432 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 7433 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 7434 * @gfp: allocation flags 7435 */ 7436 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7437 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 7438 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 7439 7440 /** 7441 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 7442 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7443 * @frame: the frame 7444 * @len: length of the frame 7445 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 7446 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7447 * 7448 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7449 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7450 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7451 */ 7452 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 7453 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 7454 7455 /** 7456 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 7457 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7458 * @frame: the frame 7459 * @len: length of the frame 7460 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 7461 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7462 * 7463 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7464 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7465 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7466 */ 7467 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7468 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 7469 int freq, int sig_dbm) 7470 { 7471 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 7472 sig_dbm); 7473 } 7474 7475 /** 7476 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 7477 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7478 * @chandef: the channel definition 7479 * @iftype: interface type 7480 * 7481 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7482 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 7483 */ 7484 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7485 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7486 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7487 7488 /** 7489 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 7490 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7491 * @chandef: the channel definition 7492 * @iftype: interface type 7493 * 7494 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7495 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 7496 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 7497 * more permissive conditions. 7498 * 7499 * Requires the RTNL to be held. 7500 */ 7501 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7502 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7503 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7504 7505 /* 7506 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 7507 * @dev: the device which switched channels 7508 * @chandef: the new channel definition 7509 * 7510 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable 7511 * driver context! 7512 */ 7513 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7514 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 7515 7516 /* 7517 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 7518 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 7519 * @chandef: the future channel definition 7520 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 7521 * 7522 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 7523 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 7524 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 7525 */ 7526 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7527 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7528 u8 count); 7529 7530 /** 7531 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 7532 * 7533 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 7534 * @band: band pointer to fill 7535 * 7536 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7537 */ 7538 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 7539 enum nl80211_band *band); 7540 7541 /** 7542 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 7543 * 7544 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7545 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 7546 * 7547 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7548 */ 7549 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7550 u8 *op_class); 7551 7552 /** 7553 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 7554 * 7555 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7556 * 7557 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 7558 */ 7559 static inline u32 7560 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 7561 { 7562 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 7563 } 7564 7565 /* 7566 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 7567 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 7568 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 7569 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 7570 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 7571 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 7572 * @gfp: allocation flags 7573 * 7574 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 7575 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 7576 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 7577 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 7578 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 7579 */ 7580 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7581 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7582 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7583 7584 /* 7585 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 7586 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 7587 * 7588 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 7589 */ 7590 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 7591 7592 /** 7593 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 7594 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 7595 * 7596 * Call this function only for wdevs that have no netdev assigned, 7597 * e.g. P2P Devices. It removes the device from the list so that 7598 * it can no longer be used. It is necessary to call this function 7599 * even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the interface by 7600 * calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also 7601 * be called when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. 7602 * when the device is unbound from the driver. 7603 * 7604 * Requires the RTNL to be held. 7605 */ 7606 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 7607 7608 /** 7609 * struct cfg80211_ft_event - FT Information Elements 7610 * @ies: FT IEs 7611 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 7612 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 7613 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 7614 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 7615 */ 7616 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 7617 const u8 *ies; 7618 size_t ies_len; 7619 const u8 *target_ap; 7620 const u8 *ric_ies; 7621 size_t ric_ies_len; 7622 }; 7623 7624 /** 7625 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 7626 * @netdev: network device 7627 * @ft_event: IE information 7628 */ 7629 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7630 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 7631 7632 /** 7633 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 7634 * @ies: the input IE buffer 7635 * @len: the input length 7636 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 7637 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 7638 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 7639 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 7640 * 7641 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 7642 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 7643 * 7644 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 7645 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 7646 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 7647 */ 7648 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 7649 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 7650 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 7651 7652 /** 7653 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 7654 * @ies: the IE buffer 7655 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7656 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7657 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7658 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7659 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7660 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 7661 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 7662 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7663 * 7664 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7665 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7666 * split. 7667 * 7668 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7669 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7670 * 7671 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7672 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7673 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7674 * 7675 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7676 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7677 * of the buffer should be used. 7678 */ 7679 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7680 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 7681 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 7682 size_t offset); 7683 7684 /** 7685 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 7686 * @ies: the IE buffer 7687 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7688 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7689 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7690 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7691 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7692 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7693 * 7694 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7695 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7696 * split. 7697 * 7698 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7699 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7700 * 7701 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7702 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7703 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7704 * 7705 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7706 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7707 * of the buffer should be used. 7708 */ 7709 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7710 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 7711 { 7712 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 7713 } 7714 7715 /** 7716 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 7717 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 7718 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 7719 * @gfp: allocation flags 7720 * 7721 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 7722 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 7723 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 7724 * else caused the wakeup. 7725 */ 7726 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7727 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7728 gfp_t gfp); 7729 7730 /** 7731 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 7732 * 7733 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 7734 * @gfp: allocation flags 7735 * 7736 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 7737 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 7738 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 7739 */ 7740 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 7741 7742 /** 7743 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 7744 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7745 * 7746 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 7747 */ 7748 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7749 7750 /** 7751 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 7752 * 7753 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7754 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7755 * 7756 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 7757 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 7758 * the interface combinations. 7759 */ 7760 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7761 struct iface_combination_params *params); 7762 7763 /** 7764 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 7765 * 7766 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7767 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7768 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 7769 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 7770 * 7771 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 7772 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 7773 * purposes. 7774 */ 7775 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7776 struct iface_combination_params *params, 7777 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 7778 void *data), 7779 void *data); 7780 7781 /* 7782 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 7783 * 7784 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7785 * @wdev: wireless device 7786 * @gfp: context flags 7787 * 7788 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 7789 * disconnected. 7790 * 7791 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 7792 */ 7793 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7794 gfp_t gfp); 7795 7796 /** 7797 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 7798 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 7799 * 7800 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 7801 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 7802 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 7803 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 7804 * 7805 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 7806 * the driver while the function is running. 7807 */ 7808 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7809 7810 /** 7811 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 7812 * 7813 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 7814 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 7815 * 7816 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 7817 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 7818 */ 7819 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7820 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 7821 { 7822 u8 *ft_byte; 7823 7824 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 7825 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 7826 } 7827 7828 /** 7829 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 7830 * 7831 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 7832 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 7833 * 7834 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 7835 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 7836 */ 7837 static inline bool 7838 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7839 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 7840 { 7841 u8 ft_byte; 7842 7843 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 7844 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 7845 } 7846 7847 /** 7848 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 7849 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 7850 * 7851 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 7852 */ 7853 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 7854 7855 /** 7856 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 7857 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 7858 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 7859 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 7860 * result. 7861 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 7862 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7863 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 7864 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 7865 * @info_len: the length of the &info 7866 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 7867 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 7868 */ 7869 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 7870 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 7871 u8 inst_id; 7872 u8 peer_inst_id; 7873 const u8 *addr; 7874 u8 info_len; 7875 const u8 *info; 7876 u64 cookie; 7877 }; 7878 7879 /** 7880 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 7881 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 7882 * @match: match notification parameters 7883 * @gfp: allocation flags 7884 * 7885 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 7886 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 7887 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 7888 */ 7889 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7890 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 7891 7892 /** 7893 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7894 * 7895 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 7896 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7897 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7898 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 7899 * @gfp: allocation flags 7900 * 7901 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 7902 */ 7903 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7904 u8 inst_id, 7905 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7906 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 7907 7908 /* ethtool helper */ 7909 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 7910 7911 /** 7912 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 7913 * @netdev: network device 7914 * @params: External authentication parameters 7915 * @gfp: allocation flags 7916 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 7917 */ 7918 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 7919 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 7920 gfp_t gfp); 7921 7922 /** 7923 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 7924 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 7925 * @req: the original measurement request 7926 * @result: the result data 7927 * @gfp: allocation flags 7928 */ 7929 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7930 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 7931 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 7932 gfp_t gfp); 7933 7934 /** 7935 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 7936 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 7937 * @req: the original measurement request 7938 * @gfp: allocation flags 7939 * 7940 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 7941 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 7942 */ 7943 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7944 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 7945 gfp_t gfp); 7946 7947 /** 7948 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 7949 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7950 * @iftype: interface type 7951 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 7952 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 7953 * 7954 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 7955 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 7956 * check_swif is '1'. 7957 */ 7958 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 7959 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 7960 7961 7962 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 7963 7964 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 7965 7966 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 7967 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7968 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7969 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7970 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7971 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7972 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7973 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7974 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7975 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7976 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7977 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7978 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7979 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7980 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7981 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7982 7983 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7984 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7985 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7986 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7987 7988 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7989 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 7990 7991 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7992 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 7993 7994 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 7995 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 7996 #else 7997 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 7998 ({ \ 7999 if (0) \ 8000 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 8001 0; \ 8002 }) 8003 #endif 8004 8005 /* 8006 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 8007 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 8008 * file/line information and a backtrace. 8009 */ 8010 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8011 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 8012 8013 /** 8014 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 8015 * @netdev: network device 8016 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 8017 * @gfp: allocation flags 8018 */ 8019 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8020 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 8021 gfp_t gfp); 8022 8023 /** 8024 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 8025 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8026 */ 8027 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8028 8029 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 8030